1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6 *
7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <linux/android_kabi.h>
27 #include <net/regulatory.h>
28
29 /**
30 * DOC: Introduction
31 *
32 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
33 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
34 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
35 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
36 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
37 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
38 *
39 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
40 * use restrictions.
41 */
42
43
44 /**
45 * DOC: Device registration
46 *
47 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
48 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
49 * described below.
50 *
51 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
52 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
53 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
54 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
55 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
56 * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
57 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
58 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
59 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
60 *
61 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
62 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
63 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
64 */
65
66 struct wiphy;
67
68 /*
69 * wireless hardware capability structures
70 */
71
72 /**
73 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
74 *
75 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
76 *
77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
78 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
79 * sending probe requests or beaconing.
80 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
81 * channel.
82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
83 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
84 * is not permitted.
85 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
86 * is not permitted.
87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
88 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
89 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
90 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
91 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
92 * restrictions.
93 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
94 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
95 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
96 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
97 * restrictions.
98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
100 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
101 * on this channel.
102 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
103 * on this channel.
104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
105 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
106 * on this channel.
107 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
108 * on this channel.
109 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
110 * on this channel.
111 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
112 * on this channel.
113 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
114 * on this channel.
115 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
116 * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
117 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
118 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
119 * restrictions.
120 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
121 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
122 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
123 * not permitted using this channel
124 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
125 * not permitted using this channel
126 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor
127 * mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions,
128 * even if it is otherwise disabled.
129 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Allow using this channel for AP operation
130 * with very low power (VLP), even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
131 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: Allow activity on a 20 MHz channel,
132 * even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
133 */
134 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
135 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = BIT(0),
136 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = BIT(1),
137 IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD = BIT(2),
138 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = BIT(3),
139 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = BIT(4),
140 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = BIT(5),
141 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = BIT(6),
142 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = BIT(7),
143 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = BIT(8),
144 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = BIT(9),
145 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = BIT(10),
146 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = BIT(11),
147 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = BIT(12),
148 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = BIT(13),
149 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = BIT(14),
150 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = BIT(15),
151 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = BIT(16),
152 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = BIT(17),
153 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = BIT(18),
154 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = BIT(19),
155 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = BIT(20),
156 IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT = BIT(21),
157 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT = BIT(22),
158 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT = BIT(23),
159 IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR = BIT(24),
160 IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP = BIT(25),
161 IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY = BIT(26),
162 };
163
164 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
165 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
166
167 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000
168 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000)
169
170 /**
171 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
172 *
173 * This structure describes a single channel for use
174 * with cfg80211.
175 *
176 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
177 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
178 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
179 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
180 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
181 * code to support devices with additional restrictions
182 * @band: band this channel belongs to.
183 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
184 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
185 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
186 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
187 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
188 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
189 * @orig_mag: internal use
190 * @orig_mpwr: internal use
191 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
192 * on this channel.
193 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
194 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
195 * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
196 */
197 struct ieee80211_channel {
198 enum nl80211_band band;
199 u32 center_freq;
200 u16 freq_offset;
201 u16 hw_value;
202 u32 flags;
203 int max_antenna_gain;
204 int max_power;
205 int max_reg_power;
206 bool beacon_found;
207 u32 orig_flags;
208 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
209 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
210 unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
211 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
212 s8 psd;
213 };
214
215 /**
216 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
217 *
218 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
219 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
220 * different bands/PHY modes.
221 *
222 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
223 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
224 * with CCK rates.
225 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
226 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
227 * core code when registering the wiphy.
228 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
229 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
230 * core code when registering the wiphy.
231 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
232 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
233 * core code when registering the wiphy.
234 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
235 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
236 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
237 */
238 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
239 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(0),
240 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = BIT(1),
241 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = BIT(2),
242 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = BIT(3),
243 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = BIT(4),
244 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = BIT(5),
245 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = BIT(6),
246 };
247
248 /**
249 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
250 *
251 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
252 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
253 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
254 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
255 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
256 */
257 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
258 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
259 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
260 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
261 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
262 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
263 };
264
265 /**
266 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
267 *
268 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
269 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
270 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
271 */
272 enum ieee80211_privacy {
273 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
274 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
275 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
276 };
277
278 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \
279 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
280
281 /**
282 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
283 *
284 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
285 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
286 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
287 * passed around.
288 *
289 * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
290 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
291 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
292 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
293 * short preamble is used
294 */
295 struct ieee80211_rate {
296 u32 flags;
297 u16 bitrate;
298 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
299 };
300
301 /**
302 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
303 *
304 * @enable: is the feature enabled.
305 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
306 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
307 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
308 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
309 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
310 * members of the SRG
311 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
312 * used by members of the SRG
313 */
314 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
315 bool enable;
316 u8 sr_ctrl;
317 u8 non_srg_max_offset;
318 u8 min_offset;
319 u8 max_offset;
320 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
321 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
322 };
323
324 /**
325 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
326 *
327 * @color: the current color.
328 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
329 * @partial: define the AID equation.
330 */
331 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
332 u8 color;
333 bool enabled;
334 bool partial;
335 };
336
337 /**
338 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
339 *
340 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
341 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
342 *
343 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
344 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
345 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
346 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
347 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
348 */
349 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
350 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
351 bool ht_supported;
352 u8 ampdu_factor;
353 u8 ampdu_density;
354 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
355 };
356
357 /**
358 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
359 *
360 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
361 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
362 *
363 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
364 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
365 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
366 */
367 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
368 bool vht_supported;
369 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
370 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
371 };
372
373 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25
374
375 /**
376 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
377 *
378 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
379 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
380 *
381 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
382 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
383 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
384 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
385 */
386 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
387 bool has_he;
388 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
389 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
390 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
391 };
392
393 /**
394 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
395 *
396 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
397 * and NSS Set field"
398 *
399 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
400 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
401 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
402 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
403 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
404 */
405 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
406 union {
407 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
408 struct {
409 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
410 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
411 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
412 } __packed bw;
413 } __packed;
414 } __packed;
415
416 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32
417
418 /**
419 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
420 *
421 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
422 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
423 *
424 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
425 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
426 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
427 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
428 */
429 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
430 bool has_eht;
431 struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
432 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
433 u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
434 };
435
436 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
437 #ifdef __CHECKER__
438 /*
439 * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
440 * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
441 * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
442 * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
443 */
444 # define __iftd __attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
445 #else
446 # define __iftd
447 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
448
449 /**
450 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
451 *
452 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
453 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the
454 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
455 *
456 * @types_mask: interface types mask
457 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
458 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
459 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
460 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
461 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
462 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
463 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
464 */
465 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
466 u16 types_mask;
467 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
468 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
469 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
470 struct {
471 const u8 *data;
472 unsigned int len;
473 } vendor_elems;
474 };
475
476 /**
477 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
478 *
479 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
480 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
481 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
482 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
483 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
484 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
485 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
486 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
487 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
488 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
489 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
490 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
491 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
492 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
493 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
494 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
495 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
496 */
497 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
498 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4,
499 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5,
500 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6,
501 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7,
502 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8,
503 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9,
504 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10,
505 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11,
506 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12,
507 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13,
508 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14,
509 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15,
510 };
511
512 /**
513 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
514 *
515 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
516 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
517 *
518 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
519 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
520 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
521 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
522 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
523 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
524 */
525 struct ieee80211_edmg {
526 u8 channels;
527 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
528 };
529
530 /**
531 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
532 *
533 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
534 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
535 *
536 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
537 * @cap: S1G capabilities information
538 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
539 */
540 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
541 bool s1g;
542 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
543 u8 nss_mcs[5];
544 };
545
546 /**
547 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
548 *
549 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
550 * is able to operate in.
551 *
552 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
553 * in this band.
554 * @band: the band this structure represents
555 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
556 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
557 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
558 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
559 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
560 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
561 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
562 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
563 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
564 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
565 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
566 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in
567 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
568 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
569 * iftype_data).
570 */
571 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
572 struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
573 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
574 enum nl80211_band band;
575 int n_channels;
576 int n_bitrates;
577 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
578 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
579 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
580 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
581 u16 n_iftype_data;
582 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
583 };
584
585 /**
586 * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
587 * @sband: the sband to initialize
588 * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
589 * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
590 *
591 * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
592 * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
593 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
594 */
595 static inline void
_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * iftd,u16 n_iftd)596 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
597 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
598 u16 n_iftd)
599 {
600 sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
601 sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
602 }
603
604 /**
605 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
606 * @sband: the sband to initialize
607 * @iftd: the iftype data array
608 */
609 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd) \
610 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
611
612 /**
613 * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
614 * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
615 * @i: iterator counter
616 * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
617 */
618 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd) \
619 for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]; \
620 i < (sband)->n_iftype_data; \
621 i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
622
623 /**
624 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
625 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
626 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
627 *
628 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
629 */
630 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)631 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
632 u8 iftype)
633 {
634 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
635 int i;
636
637 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES))
638 return NULL;
639
640 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
641 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
642
643 for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
644 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
645 return data;
646 }
647
648 return NULL;
649 }
650
651 /**
652 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
653 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
654 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
655 *
656 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
657 */
658 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)659 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
660 u8 iftype)
661 {
662 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
663 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
664
665 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
666 return &data->he_cap;
667
668 return NULL;
669 }
670
671 /**
672 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
673 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
674 * @iftype: the iftype to search for
675 *
676 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
677 */
678 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)679 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
680 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
681 {
682 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
683 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
684
685 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
686 return 0;
687
688 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
689 }
690
691 /**
692 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
693 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
694 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
695 *
696 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
697 */
698 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)699 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
700 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
701 {
702 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
703 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
704
705 if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
706 return &data->eht_cap;
707
708 return NULL;
709 }
710
711 /**
712 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
713 *
714 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
715 *
716 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
717 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
718 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
719 *
720 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
721 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
722 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
723 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
724 * without affecting other devices.
725 *
726 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
727 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
728 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
729 */
730 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
731 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
732 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)733 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
734 {
735 }
736 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
737
738
739 /*
740 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
741 */
742
743 /**
744 * DOC: Actions and configuration
745 *
746 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
747 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
748 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
749 * operations use are described separately.
750 *
751 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
752 * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
753 *
754 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
755 * in a separate chapter.
756 */
757
758 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
759 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
760
761 /**
762 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
763 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
764 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
765 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
766 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
767 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
768 * determine the address as needed.
769 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
770 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating
771 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC.
772 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
773 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
774 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
775 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
776 */
777 struct vif_params {
778 u32 flags;
779 int use_4addr;
780 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
781 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
782 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
783 };
784
785 /**
786 * struct key_params - key information
787 *
788 * Information about a key
789 *
790 * @key: key material
791 * @key_len: length of key material
792 * @cipher: cipher suite selector
793 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
794 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
795 * length given by @seq_len.
796 * @seq_len: length of @seq.
797 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
798 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
799 */
800 struct key_params {
801 const u8 *key;
802 const u8 *seq;
803 int key_len;
804 int seq_len;
805 u16 vlan_id;
806 u32 cipher;
807 enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
808 };
809
810 /**
811 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
812 * @chan: the (control) channel
813 * @width: channel width
814 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
815 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
816 * (only with 80+80 MHz)
817 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
818 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
819 * chan will define the primary channel and all other
820 * parameters are ignored.
821 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
822 * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with
823 * bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered
824 * from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec)
825 */
826 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
827 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
828 enum nl80211_chan_width width;
829 u32 center_freq1;
830 u32 center_freq2;
831 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
832 u16 freq1_offset;
833 u16 punctured;
834 };
835
836 /*
837 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
838 */
839 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
840 struct {
841 u32 legacy;
842 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
843 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
844 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
845 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
846 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
847 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
848 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
849 };
850
851
852 /**
853 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
854 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
855 * of the peer.
856 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
857 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
858 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
859 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
860 * @retry_long: retry count value
861 * @retry_short: retry count value
862 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
863 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
864 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
865 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
866 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
867 */
868 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
869 bool config_override;
870 u8 tids;
871 u64 mask;
872 enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
873 u8 retry_long, retry_short;
874 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
875 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
876 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
877 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
878 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
879 };
880
881 /**
882 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
883 * @peer: Station's MAC address
884 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
885 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
886 */
887 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
888 const u8 *peer;
889 u32 n_tid_conf;
890 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
891 };
892
893 /**
894 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
895 * @macaddr: STA MAC address
896 * @kek: FILS KEK
897 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
898 * @snonce: STA Nonce
899 * @anonce: AP Nonce
900 */
901 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
902 const u8 *macaddr;
903 const u8 *kek;
904 u8 kek_len;
905 const u8 *snonce;
906 const u8 *anonce;
907 };
908
909 /**
910 * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
911 * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
912 * addresses.
913 * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
914 * Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
915 */
916 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
917 const u8 *macaddr;
918 bool enable;
919 };
920
921 /**
922 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
923 * @chandef: the channel definition
924 *
925 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
926 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
927 */
928 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)929 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
930 {
931 switch (chandef->width) {
932 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
933 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
934 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
935 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
936 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
937 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
938 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
939 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
940 default:
941 WARN_ON(1);
942 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
943 }
944 }
945
946 /**
947 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
948 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
949 * @channel: the control channel
950 * @chantype: the channel type
951 *
952 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
953 */
954 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
955 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
956 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
957
958 /**
959 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
960 * @chandef1: first channel definition
961 * @chandef2: second channel definition
962 *
963 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
964 * identical, %false otherwise.
965 */
966 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)967 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
968 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
969 {
970 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
971 chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
972 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
973 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
974 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 &&
975 chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured);
976 }
977
978 /**
979 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
980 *
981 * @chandef: the channel definition
982 *
983 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
984 */
985 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)986 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
987 {
988 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
989 }
990
991 /**
992 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
993 * @chandef1: first channel definition
994 * @chandef2: second channel definition
995 *
996 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
997 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
998 */
999 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
1000 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
1001 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
1002
1003 /**
1004 * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
1005 * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1006 *
1007 * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1008 * is valid. -1 otherwise.
1009 */
1010 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
1011
1012 /**
1013 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
1014 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1015 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1016 */
1017 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1018
1019 /**
1020 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1021 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1022 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1023 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1024 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1025 */
1026 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1027 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1028 u32 prohibited_flags);
1029
1030 /**
1031 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1032 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1033 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1034 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1035 * Returns:
1036 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1037 */
1038 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1039 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1040 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1041
1042 /**
1043 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1044 * can/need start CAC on such channel
1045 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1046 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1047 *
1048 * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1049 * one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1050 */
1051 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1052 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1053
1054 /**
1055 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1056 * channel definition
1057 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1058 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1059 *
1060 * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1061 */
1062 unsigned int
1063 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1064 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1065
1066 /**
1067 * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq
1068 * @chandef: chandef to calculate for
1069 * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for
1070 * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated
1071 * according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL
1072 *
1073 * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1
1074 * for errors, updating the punctured bitmap
1075 */
1076 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1077 enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width,
1078 u16 *punctured);
1079
1080 /**
1081 * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1082 * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1083 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1084 *
1085 * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1086 **/
1087 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1088
1089 /**
1090 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1091 * @width: the channel width of the channel
1092 *
1093 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1094 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1095 *
1096 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1097 */
1098 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)1099 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1100 {
1101 switch (width) {
1102 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1103 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1104 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1105 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1106 default:
1107 break;
1108 }
1109 return 0;
1110 }
1111
1112 /**
1113 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1114 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1115 *
1116 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1117 *
1118 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1119 */
1120 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1121 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1122 {
1123 return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1124 }
1125
1126 /**
1127 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1128 *
1129 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1130 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1131 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1132 *
1133 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1134 *
1135 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1136 */
1137 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1138 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1139 {
1140 switch (chandef->width) {
1141 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1142 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1143 chandef->chan->max_power);
1144 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1145 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1146 chandef->chan->max_power);
1147 default:
1148 break;
1149 }
1150 return chandef->chan->max_power;
1151 }
1152
1153 /**
1154 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1155 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1156 * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1157 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1158 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1159 *
1160 * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise
1161 */
1162 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1163 unsigned long band_mask,
1164 u32 prohibited_flags);
1165
1166 /**
1167 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1168 *
1169 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1170 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1171 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1172 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1173 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1174 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1175 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1176 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1177 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1178 *
1179 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1180 * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1181 */
1182 enum survey_info_flags {
1183 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0),
1184 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1),
1185 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2),
1186 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3),
1187 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4),
1188 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5),
1189 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6),
1190 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7),
1191 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8),
1192 };
1193
1194 /**
1195 * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1196 *
1197 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1198 * record to report global statistics
1199 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1200 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1201 * optional
1202 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1203 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1204 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1205 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1206 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1207 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1208 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1209 *
1210 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1211 *
1212 * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1213 * channel duty cycle etc.
1214 */
1215 struct survey_info {
1216 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1217 u64 time;
1218 u64 time_busy;
1219 u64 time_ext_busy;
1220 u64 time_rx;
1221 u64 time_tx;
1222 u64 time_scan;
1223 u64 time_bss_rx;
1224 u32 filled;
1225 s8 noise;
1226 };
1227
1228 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10
1229
1230 /**
1231 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1232 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1233 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1234 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1235 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1236 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1237 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1238 * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1239 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1240 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1241 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1242 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1243 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1244 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1245 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1246 * protocol frames.
1247 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1248 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1249 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1250 * port for mac80211
1251 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1252 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1253 * offload)
1254 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1255 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1256 *
1257 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1258 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1259 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1260 * such a scenario.
1261 *
1262 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1263 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1264 *
1265 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1266 * Allow hash-to-element only
1267 *
1268 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1269 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1270 */
1271 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1272 u32 wpa_versions;
1273 u32 cipher_group;
1274 int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1275 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1276 int n_akm_suites;
1277 u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1278 bool control_port;
1279 __be16 control_port_ethertype;
1280 bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1281 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1282 bool control_port_no_preauth;
1283 const u8 *psk;
1284 const u8 *sae_pwd;
1285 u8 sae_pwd_len;
1286 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1287
1288 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1289 };
1290
1291 /**
1292 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1293 *
1294 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1295 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1296 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1297 */
1298 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1299 struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1300 u8 index;
1301 bool ema;
1302 };
1303
1304 /**
1305 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1306 *
1307 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1308 *
1309 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1310 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1311 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1312 */
1313 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1314 u8 cnt;
1315 struct {
1316 const u8 *data;
1317 size_t len;
1318 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1319 };
1320
1321 /**
1322 * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1323 *
1324 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1325 *
1326 * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1327 * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1328 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1329 */
1330 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1331 u8 cnt;
1332 struct {
1333 const u8 *data;
1334 size_t len;
1335 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1336 };
1337
1338 /**
1339 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1340 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1341 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1342 * or %NULL if not changed
1343 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1344 * or %NULL if not changed
1345 * @head_len: length of @head
1346 * @tail_len: length of @tail
1347 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1348 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1349 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1350 * frames or %NULL
1351 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1352 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1353 * Response frames or %NULL
1354 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1355 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1356 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1357 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1358 * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1359 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1360 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1361 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1362 * (measurement type 8)
1363 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1364 * Token (measurement type 11)
1365 * @lci_len: LCI data length
1366 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1367 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1368 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1369 * attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1370 */
1371 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1372 unsigned int link_id;
1373
1374 const u8 *head, *tail;
1375 const u8 *beacon_ies;
1376 const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1377 const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1378 const u8 *probe_resp;
1379 const u8 *lci;
1380 const u8 *civicloc;
1381 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1382 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1383 s8 ftm_responder;
1384
1385 size_t head_len, tail_len;
1386 size_t beacon_ies_len;
1387 size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1388 size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1389 size_t probe_resp_len;
1390 size_t lci_len;
1391 size_t civicloc_len;
1392 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1393 bool he_bss_color_valid;
1394
1395 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1396 };
1397
1398 struct mac_address {
1399 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1400 };
1401
1402 /**
1403 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1404 *
1405 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1406 * entry specified by mac_addr
1407 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1408 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1409 */
1410 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1411 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1412 int n_acl_entries;
1413
1414 /* Keep it last */
1415 struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1416 };
1417
1418 /**
1419 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1420 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1421 *
1422 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1423 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1424 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1425 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1426 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1427 * frame headers.
1428 */
1429 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1430 bool update;
1431 u32 min_interval;
1432 u32 max_interval;
1433 size_t tmpl_len;
1434 const u8 *tmpl;
1435 };
1436
1437 /**
1438 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1439 * response parameters in 6GHz.
1440 *
1441 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1442 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1443 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1444 * scanning
1445 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1446 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1447 */
1448 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1449 bool update;
1450 u32 interval;
1451 size_t tmpl_len;
1452 const u8 *tmpl;
1453 };
1454
1455 /**
1456 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1457 *
1458 * Used to configure an AP interface.
1459 *
1460 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1461 * @beacon: beacon data
1462 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1463 * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1464 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1465 * user space)
1466 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1467 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1468 * @crypto: crypto settings
1469 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1470 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1471 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1472 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1473 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1474 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1475 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1476 * MAC address based access control
1477 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1478 * networks.
1479 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1480 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1481 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1482 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1483 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1484 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1485 * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1486 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1487 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1488 * @he_required: stations must support HE
1489 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1490 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1491 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1492 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1493 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1494 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1495 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1496 */
1497 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1498 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1499
1500 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1501
1502 int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1503 const u8 *ssid;
1504 size_t ssid_len;
1505 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1506 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1507 bool privacy;
1508 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1509 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1510 int inactivity_timeout;
1511 u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1512 bool p2p_opp_ps;
1513 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1514 bool pbss;
1515 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1516
1517 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1518 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1519 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1520 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1521 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1522 const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1523 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1524 bool twt_responder;
1525 u32 flags;
1526 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1527 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1528 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1529 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1530
1531 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1532 };
1533
1534
1535 /**
1536 * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1537 *
1538 * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1539 *
1540 * @beacon: beacon data
1541 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1542 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1543 */
1544 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1545 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1546 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1547 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1548
1549 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1550 };
1551
1552 /**
1553 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1554 *
1555 * Used for channel switch
1556 *
1557 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1558 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1559 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1560 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1561 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1562 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1563 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1564 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1565 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1566 * @count: number of beacons until switch
1567 * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during
1568 * MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO.
1569 */
1570 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1571 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1572 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1573 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1574 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1575 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1576 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1577 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1578 bool radar_required;
1579 bool block_tx;
1580 u8 count;
1581 u8 link_id;
1582
1583 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1584 };
1585
1586 /**
1587 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1588 *
1589 * Used for bss color change
1590 *
1591 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1592 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1593 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1594 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1595 * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1596 * @color: the color used after the change
1597 * @link_id: defines the link on which color change is expected during MLO.
1598 * 0 in case of non-MLO.
1599 */
1600 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1601 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1602 u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1603 u16 counter_offset_presp;
1604 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1605 u8 count;
1606 u8 color;
1607 u8 link_id;
1608 };
1609
1610 /**
1611 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1612 *
1613 * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1614 *
1615 * @radio_idx: wiphy radio index or -1 for global
1616 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1617 * to use for verification
1618 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1619 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1620 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1621 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1622 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1623 * nl80211_iftype.
1624 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1625 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1626 * the verification
1627 */
1628 struct iface_combination_params {
1629 int radio_idx;
1630 int num_different_channels;
1631 u8 radar_detect;
1632 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1633 u32 new_beacon_int;
1634 };
1635
1636 /**
1637 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1638 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1639 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1640 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1641 *
1642 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1643 * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1644 */
1645 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1646 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1647 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1648 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1649 };
1650
1651 /**
1652 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1653 *
1654 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1655 *
1656 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1657 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1658 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1659 * power per-interface or per-station.
1660 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1661 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1662 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1663 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1664 * per peer TPC.
1665 */
1666 struct sta_txpwr {
1667 s16 power;
1668 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1669 };
1670
1671 /**
1672 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1673 *
1674 * Used to change and create a new link station.
1675 *
1676 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1677 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1678 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1679 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1680 * (or NULL for no change)
1681 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1682 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1683 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1684 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1685 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1686 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1687 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1688 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1689 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1690 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1691 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1692 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1693 */
1694 struct link_station_parameters {
1695 const u8 *mld_mac;
1696 int link_id;
1697 const u8 *link_mac;
1698 const u8 *supported_rates;
1699 u8 supported_rates_len;
1700 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1701 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1702 u8 opmode_notif;
1703 bool opmode_notif_used;
1704 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1705 u8 he_capa_len;
1706 struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1707 bool txpwr_set;
1708 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1709 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1710 u8 eht_capa_len;
1711
1712 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1713 };
1714
1715 /**
1716 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1717 *
1718 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1719 *
1720 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1721 * @link_id: the link id
1722 */
1723 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1724 const u8 *mld_mac;
1725 u32 link_id;
1726 };
1727
1728 /**
1729 * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1730 *
1731 * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1732 *
1733 * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1734 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1735 * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1736 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1737 */
1738 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1739 u16 dlink[8];
1740 u16 ulink[8];
1741 };
1742
1743 /**
1744 * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1745 *
1746 * Used to change and create a new station.
1747 *
1748 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1749 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1750 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1751 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1752 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1753 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1754 * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1755 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1756 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1757 * @plink_action: plink action to take
1758 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1759 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1760 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1761 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1762 * QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1763 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1764 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1765 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1766 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1767 * to unknown)
1768 * @capability: station capability
1769 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1770 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1771 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1772 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1773 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1774 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1775 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1776 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1777 * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1778 */
1779 struct station_parameters {
1780 struct net_device *vlan;
1781 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1782 u32 sta_modify_mask;
1783 int listen_interval;
1784 u16 aid;
1785 u16 vlan_id;
1786 u16 peer_aid;
1787 u8 plink_action;
1788 u8 plink_state;
1789 u8 uapsd_queues;
1790 u8 max_sp;
1791 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1792 u16 capability;
1793 const u8 *ext_capab;
1794 u8 ext_capab_len;
1795 const u8 *supported_channels;
1796 u8 supported_channels_len;
1797 const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1798 u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1799 int support_p2p_ps;
1800 u16 airtime_weight;
1801 struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1802 };
1803
1804 /**
1805 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1806 *
1807 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1808 *
1809 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1810 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1811 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1812 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1813 * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be
1814 * using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really
1815 * remove all stations.
1816 */
1817 struct station_del_parameters {
1818 const u8 *mac;
1819 u8 subtype;
1820 u16 reason_code;
1821 int link_id;
1822 };
1823
1824 /**
1825 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1826 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1827 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1828 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1829 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1830 * the AP MLME in the device
1831 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1832 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1833 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1834 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1835 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1836 * supported/used)
1837 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1838 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1839 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1840 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1841 */
1842 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1843 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1844 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1845 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1846 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1847 CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1848 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1849 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1850 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1851 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1852 };
1853
1854 /**
1855 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1856 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1857 * @params: the new parameters for a station
1858 * @statype: the type of station being modified
1859 *
1860 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1861 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1862 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable.
1863 *
1864 * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that
1865 * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't
1866 * use them before calling this.
1867 */
1868 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1869 struct station_parameters *params,
1870 enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1871
1872 /**
1873 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1874 *
1875 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1876 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1877 *
1878 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1879 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1880 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1881 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1882 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1883 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1884 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1885 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1886 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1887 */
1888 enum rate_info_flags {
1889 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0),
1890 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1),
1891 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1892 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3),
1893 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4),
1894 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5),
1895 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6),
1896 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7),
1897 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS = BIT(8),
1898 };
1899
1900 /**
1901 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1902 *
1903 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1904 *
1905 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1906 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1907 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1908 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1909 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1910 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1911 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1912 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1913 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1914 * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1915 * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1916 * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1917 * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1918 * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1919 */
1920 enum rate_info_bw {
1921 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1922 RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1923 RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1924 RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1925 RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1926 RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1927 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1928 RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1929 RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1930 RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1931 RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1932 RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1933 RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1934 RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1935 };
1936
1937 /**
1938 * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1939 *
1940 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1941 *
1942 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1943 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1944 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1945 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1946 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1947 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1948 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1949 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1950 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1951 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1952 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1953 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1954 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1955 */
1956 struct rate_info {
1957 u16 flags;
1958 u16 legacy;
1959 u8 mcs;
1960 u8 nss;
1961 u8 bw;
1962 u8 he_gi;
1963 u8 he_dcm;
1964 u8 he_ru_alloc;
1965 u8 n_bonded_ch;
1966 u8 eht_gi;
1967 u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1968 };
1969
1970 /**
1971 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1972 *
1973 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1974 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1975 *
1976 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1977 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1978 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1979 */
1980 enum bss_param_flags {
1981 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = BIT(0),
1982 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(1),
1983 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = BIT(2),
1984 };
1985
1986 /**
1987 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1988 *
1989 * Information about the currently associated BSS
1990 *
1991 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1992 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1993 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1994 */
1995 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1996 u8 flags;
1997 u8 dtim_period;
1998 u16 beacon_interval;
1999 };
2000
2001 /**
2002 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
2003 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
2004 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2005 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
2006 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
2007 * @flows: number of new flows seen
2008 * @drops: total number of packets dropped
2009 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
2010 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
2011 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
2012 * @collisions: number of hash collisions
2013 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
2014 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
2015 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
2016 */
2017 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
2018 u32 filled;
2019 u32 backlog_bytes;
2020 u32 backlog_packets;
2021 u32 flows;
2022 u32 drops;
2023 u32 ecn_marks;
2024 u32 overlimit;
2025 u32 overmemory;
2026 u32 collisions;
2027 u32 tx_bytes;
2028 u32 tx_packets;
2029 u32 max_flows;
2030 };
2031
2032 /**
2033 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
2034 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
2035 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2036 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
2037 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
2038 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
2039 * transmitted MSDUs
2040 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
2041 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
2042 */
2043 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
2044 u32 filled;
2045 u64 rx_msdu;
2046 u64 tx_msdu;
2047 u64 tx_msdu_retries;
2048 u64 tx_msdu_failed;
2049 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2050 };
2051
2052 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4
2053
2054 /**
2055 * struct station_info - station information
2056 *
2057 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2058 *
2059 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2060 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2061 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2062 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2063 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2064 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2065 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2066 * @llid: mesh local link id
2067 * @plid: mesh peer link id
2068 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2069 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2070 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2071 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2072 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2073 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2074 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2075 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2076 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2077 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2078 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2079 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2080 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2081 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2082 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason.
2083 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2084 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2085 * This number should increase every time the list of stations
2086 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2087 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2088 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2089 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2090 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2091 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2092 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2093 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2094 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2095 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2096 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2097 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2098 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2099 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2100 * towards this station.
2101 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2102 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2103 * from this peer
2104 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2105 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2106 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2107 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2108 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2109 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2110 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2111 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2112 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2113 * been sent.
2114 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2115 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2116 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2117 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2118 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2119 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2120 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2121 * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2122 * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2123 * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2124 * dump_station() callbacks.
2125 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2126 * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2127 * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2128 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2129 * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2130 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2131 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2132 * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2133 * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2134 * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2135 * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2136 * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2137 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2138 */
2139 struct station_info {
2140 u64 filled;
2141 u32 connected_time;
2142 u32 inactive_time;
2143 u64 assoc_at;
2144 u64 rx_bytes;
2145 u64 tx_bytes;
2146 u16 llid;
2147 u16 plid;
2148 u8 plink_state;
2149 s8 signal;
2150 s8 signal_avg;
2151
2152 u8 chains;
2153 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2154 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2155
2156 struct rate_info txrate;
2157 struct rate_info rxrate;
2158 u32 rx_packets;
2159 u32 tx_packets;
2160 u32 tx_retries;
2161 u32 tx_failed;
2162 u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2163 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2164 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2165
2166 int generation;
2167
2168 const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2169 size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2170
2171 u32 beacon_loss_count;
2172 s64 t_offset;
2173 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2174 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2175 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2176
2177 u32 expected_throughput;
2178
2179 u64 tx_duration;
2180 u64 rx_duration;
2181 u64 rx_beacon;
2182 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2183 u8 connected_to_gate;
2184
2185 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2186 s8 ack_signal;
2187 s8 avg_ack_signal;
2188
2189 u16 airtime_weight;
2190
2191 u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2192 u32 fcs_err_count;
2193
2194 u32 airtime_link_metric;
2195
2196 u8 connected_to_as;
2197
2198 bool mlo_params_valid;
2199 u8 assoc_link_id;
2200 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2201 const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2202 size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2203
2204 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2205 };
2206
2207 /**
2208 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2209 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2210 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2211 */
2212 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2213 s32 power;
2214 u32 freq_range_index;
2215 };
2216
2217 /**
2218 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2219 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2220 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2221 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2222 */
2223 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2224 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2225 u32 num_sub_specs;
2226 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[] __counted_by(num_sub_specs);
2227 };
2228
2229
2230 /**
2231 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2232 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency
2233 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency
2234 */
2235 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2236 u32 start_freq;
2237 u32 end_freq;
2238 };
2239
2240 /**
2241 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2242 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2243 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2244 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2245 *
2246 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2247 * range to small ones and then append them.
2248 */
2249 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2250 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2251 u32 num_freq_ranges;
2252 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2253 };
2254
2255 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2256 /**
2257 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2258 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2259 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2260 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2261 *
2262 * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2263 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2264 * considered undefined.
2265 */
2266 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2267 struct station_info *sinfo);
2268 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2269 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2270 const u8 *mac_addr,
2271 struct station_info *sinfo)
2272 {
2273 return -ENOENT;
2274 }
2275 #endif
2276
2277 /**
2278 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2279 *
2280 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2281 * according to the nl80211 flags.
2282 *
2283 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2284 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2285 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2286 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2287 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2288 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2289 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2290 */
2291 enum monitor_flags {
2292 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = BIT(__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID),
2293 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL),
2294 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL),
2295 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL),
2296 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS),
2297 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES),
2298 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE),
2299 };
2300
2301 /**
2302 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags
2303 *
2304 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2305 * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2306 *
2307 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2308 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2309 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2310 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2311 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2312 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2313 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2314 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2315 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2316 */
2317 enum mpath_info_flags {
2318 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0),
2319 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1),
2320 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2),
2321 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3),
2322 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4),
2323 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5),
2324 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6),
2325 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7),
2326 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8),
2327 };
2328
2329 /**
2330 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2331 *
2332 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2333 *
2334 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2335 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2336 * @sn: target sequence number
2337 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2338 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2339 * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2340 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2341 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2342 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2343 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2344 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2345 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2346 * @hop_count: hops to destination
2347 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2348 */
2349 struct mpath_info {
2350 u32 filled;
2351 u32 frame_qlen;
2352 u32 sn;
2353 u32 metric;
2354 u32 exptime;
2355 u32 discovery_timeout;
2356 u8 discovery_retries;
2357 u8 flags;
2358 u8 hop_count;
2359 u32 path_change_count;
2360
2361 int generation;
2362 };
2363
2364 /**
2365 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2366 *
2367 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2368 *
2369 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2370 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2371 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2372 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2373 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2374 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2375 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2376 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2377 * (or NULL for no change)
2378 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2379 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2380 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2381 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2382 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2383 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2384 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2385 */
2386 struct bss_parameters {
2387 int link_id;
2388 int use_cts_prot;
2389 int use_short_preamble;
2390 int use_short_slot_time;
2391 const u8 *basic_rates;
2392 u8 basic_rates_len;
2393 int ap_isolate;
2394 int ht_opmode;
2395 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2396 };
2397
2398 /**
2399 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2400 *
2401 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2402 *
2403 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2404 * by the Mesh Peering Open message
2405 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2406 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2407 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2408 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2409 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2410 * mesh interface
2411 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2412 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2413 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2414 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2415 * elements
2416 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2417 * detect compatible mesh peers
2418 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2419 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2420 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2421 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2422 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2423 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2424 * a path discovery in milliseconds
2425 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2426 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2427 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2428 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2429 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2430 * element
2431 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2432 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2433 * element
2434 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2435 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2436 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2437 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2438 * announcements are transmitted
2439 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2440 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2441 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2442 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2443 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2444 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2445 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2446 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2447 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2448 * station to establish a peer link
2449 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2450 *
2451 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2452 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2453 * the root mesh STA to be valid.
2454 *
2455 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2456 * PREQs are transmitted.
2457 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2458 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2459 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2460 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2461 * setting for new peer links.
2462 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2463 * after transmitting its beacon.
2464 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2465 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2466 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes.
2467 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2468 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2469 * in the mesh formation field.
2470 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2471 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the
2472 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2473 * in the mesh path table
2474 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2475 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2476 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2477 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2478 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2479 */
2480 struct mesh_config {
2481 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2482 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2483 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2484 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2485 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2486 u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2487 u8 element_ttl;
2488 bool auto_open_plinks;
2489 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2490 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2491 u32 path_refresh_time;
2492 u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2493 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2494 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2495 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2496 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2497 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2498 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2499 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2500 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2501 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2502 bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2503 s32 rssi_threshold;
2504 u16 ht_opmode;
2505 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2506 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2507 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2508 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2509 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2510 u32 plink_timeout;
2511 bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2512
2513 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2514 };
2515
2516 /**
2517 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2518 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2519 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2520 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2521 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2522 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2523 * @path_metric: which metric to use
2524 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2525 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2526 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2527 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2528 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2529 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2530 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2531 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2532 * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2533 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2534 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2535 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2536 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2537 * to operate on DFS channels.
2538 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2539 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2540 *
2541 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2542 */
2543 struct mesh_setup {
2544 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2545 const u8 *mesh_id;
2546 u8 mesh_id_len;
2547 u8 sync_method;
2548 u8 path_sel_proto;
2549 u8 path_metric;
2550 u8 auth_id;
2551 const u8 *ie;
2552 u8 ie_len;
2553 bool is_authenticated;
2554 bool is_secure;
2555 bool user_mpm;
2556 u8 dtim_period;
2557 u16 beacon_interval;
2558 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2559 u32 basic_rates;
2560 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2561 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2562 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2563
2564 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2565 };
2566
2567 /**
2568 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2569 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2570 *
2571 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2572 */
2573 struct ocb_setup {
2574 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2575 };
2576
2577 /**
2578 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2579 * @ac: AC identifier
2580 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2581 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2582 * 1..32767]
2583 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2584 * 1..32767]
2585 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2586 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2587 */
2588 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2589 enum nl80211_ac ac;
2590 u16 txop;
2591 u16 cwmin;
2592 u16 cwmax;
2593 u8 aifs;
2594 int link_id;
2595 };
2596
2597 /**
2598 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2599 *
2600 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2601 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2602 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2603 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2604 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2605 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2606 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2607 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2608 * in the wiphy structure.
2609 *
2610 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2611 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2612 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2613 *
2614 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2615 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2616 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2617 * to userspace.
2618 */
2619
2620 /**
2621 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2622 * @ssid: the SSID
2623 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2624 */
2625 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2626 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2627 u8 ssid_len;
2628 };
2629
2630 /**
2631 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2632 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2633 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2634 * information is not available, this field is left zero.
2635 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2636 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2637 * userspace will be notified of that
2638 */
2639 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2640 u64 scan_start_tsf;
2641 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2642 bool aborted;
2643 };
2644
2645 /**
2646 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2647 *
2648 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2649 * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2650 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2651 * which the above info is relevant to
2652 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2653 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2654 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2655 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2656 * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2657 */
2658 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2659 u32 short_ssid;
2660 u32 channel_idx;
2661 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2662 bool unsolicited_probe;
2663 bool short_ssid_valid;
2664 bool psc_no_listen;
2665 s8 psd_20;
2666 };
2667
2668 /**
2669 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2670 *
2671 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2672 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2673 * @channels: channels to scan on.
2674 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2675 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2676 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2677 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2678 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2679 * the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2680 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2681 * %duration field.
2682 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2683 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2684 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2685 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2686 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2687 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2688 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2689 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2690 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2691 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2692 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2693 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2694 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2695 * true if this is the second scan request
2696 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2697 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2698 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2699 * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2700 * used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2701 */
2702 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2703 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2704 int n_ssids;
2705 u32 n_channels;
2706 const u8 *ie;
2707 size_t ie_len;
2708 u16 duration;
2709 bool duration_mandatory;
2710 u32 flags;
2711
2712 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2713
2714 struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2715
2716 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2717 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2718 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2719
2720 /* internal */
2721 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2722 unsigned long scan_start;
2723 struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2724 bool notified;
2725 bool no_cck;
2726 bool scan_6ghz;
2727 u32 n_6ghz_params;
2728 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2729 s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2730
2731 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2732
2733 /* keep last */
2734 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2735 };
2736
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2737 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2738 {
2739 int i;
2740
2741 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2742 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2743 buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2744 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2745 }
2746 }
2747
2748 /**
2749 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2750 *
2751 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2752 * or no match (RSSI only)
2753 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2754 * or no match (RSSI only)
2755 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2756 */
2757 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2758 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2759 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2760 s32 rssi_thold;
2761 };
2762
2763 /**
2764 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2765 *
2766 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2767 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2768 * infinite loop.
2769 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2770 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2771 */
2772 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2773 u32 interval;
2774 u32 iterations;
2775 };
2776
2777 /**
2778 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2779 *
2780 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2781 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2782 */
2783 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2784 enum nl80211_band band;
2785 s8 delta;
2786 };
2787
2788 /**
2789 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2790 *
2791 * @reqid: identifies this request.
2792 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2793 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2794 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2795 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2796 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2797 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2798 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2799 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2800 * (others are filtered out).
2801 * If omitted, all results are passed.
2802 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2803 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2804 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2805 * @dev: the interface
2806 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2807 * @channels: channels to scan
2808 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2809 * contains the minimum over all matchsets
2810 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2811 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2812 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2813 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2814 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2815 * index must be executed first.
2816 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2817 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2818 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2819 * owned by a particular socket)
2820 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2821 * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2822 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2823 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2824 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2825 * supported.
2826 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2827 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2828 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2829 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2830 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2831 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2832 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2833 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2834 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2835 * comparisons.
2836 */
2837 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2838 u64 reqid;
2839 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2840 int n_ssids;
2841 u32 n_channels;
2842 const u8 *ie;
2843 size_t ie_len;
2844 u32 flags;
2845 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2846 int n_match_sets;
2847 s32 min_rssi_thold;
2848 u32 delay;
2849 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2850 int n_scan_plans;
2851
2852 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2853 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2854
2855 bool relative_rssi_set;
2856 s8 relative_rssi;
2857 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2858
2859 /* internal */
2860 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2861 struct net_device *dev;
2862 unsigned long scan_start;
2863 bool report_results;
2864 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2865 u32 owner_nlportid;
2866 bool nl_owner_dead;
2867 struct list_head list;
2868
2869 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2870
2871 /* keep last */
2872 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2873 };
2874
2875 /**
2876 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2877 *
2878 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2879 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2880 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2881 */
2882 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2883 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2884 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2885 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2886 };
2887
2888 /**
2889 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2890 * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2891 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2892 * signal type
2893 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2894 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2895 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2896 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2897 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2898 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2899 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2900 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2901 * by %parent_bssid.
2902 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2903 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2904 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2905 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2906 * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2907 * %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2908 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2909 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2910 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2911 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2912 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2913 * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2914 */
2915 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2916 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2917 s32 signal;
2918 u64 boottime_ns;
2919 u64 parent_tsf;
2920 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2921 u8 chains;
2922 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2923
2924 u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2925 u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2926
2927 void *drv_data;
2928 };
2929
2930 /**
2931 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2932 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2933 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2934 * @len: length of the IEs
2935 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2936 * @data: IE data
2937 */
2938 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2939 u64 tsf;
2940 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2941 int len;
2942 bool from_beacon;
2943 u8 data[];
2944 };
2945
2946 /**
2947 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2948 *
2949 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2950 * for use in scan results and similar.
2951 *
2952 * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2953 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2954 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2955 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2956 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2957 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2958 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2959 * received. It is always non-%NULL.
2960 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2961 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2962 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2963 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2964 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2965 * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2966 * cannot rely on it having valid data
2967 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2968 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2969 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2970 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2971 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2972 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2973 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2974 * (multi-BSSID support)
2975 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2976 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2977 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2978 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2979 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2980 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2981 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2982 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2983 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2984 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2985 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2986 */
2987 struct cfg80211_bss {
2988 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2989
2990 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2991 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2992 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2993
2994 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2995 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2996 struct list_head nontrans_list;
2997
2998 s32 signal;
2999
3000 u16 beacon_interval;
3001 u16 capability;
3002
3003 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
3004 u8 chains;
3005 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
3006
3007 u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
3008
3009 u8 bssid_index;
3010 u8 max_bssid_indicator;
3011
3012 u8 use_for;
3013 u8 cannot_use_reasons;
3014 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3015
3016 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
3017 };
3018
3019 /**
3020 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
3021 * @bss: the bss to search
3022 * @id: the element ID
3023 *
3024 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3025 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3026 * Return: %NULL if not found.
3027 */
3028 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
3029
3030 /**
3031 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
3032 * @bss: the bss to search
3033 * @id: the element ID
3034 *
3035 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3036 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3037 * Return: %NULL if not found.
3038 */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)3039 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
3040 {
3041 return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
3042 }
3043
3044
3045 /**
3046 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
3047 *
3048 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3049 * authentication.
3050 *
3051 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
3052 * to it if it needs to keep it.
3053 * @supported_selectors: List of selectors that should be assumed to be
3054 * supported by the station.
3055 * SAE_H2E must be assumed supported if set to %NULL.
3056 * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets.
3057 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3058 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3059 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3060 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3061 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3062 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3063 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3064 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3065 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3066 * transaction sequence number field.
3067 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3068 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3069 * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3070 * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3071 * given an MLD address) by the driver
3072 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3073 * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3074 */
3075 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3076 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3077 const u8 *ie;
3078 size_t ie_len;
3079 const u8 *supported_selectors;
3080 u8 supported_selectors_len;
3081 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3082 const u8 *key;
3083 u8 key_len;
3084 s8 key_idx;
3085 const u8 *auth_data;
3086 size_t auth_data_len;
3087 s8 link_id;
3088 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3089 };
3090
3091 /**
3092 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3093 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3094 * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3095 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3096 * @elems_len: length of the elements
3097 * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3098 * should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3099 * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3100 * operation as a whole must fail.
3101 */
3102 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3103 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3104 const u8 *elems;
3105 size_t elems_len;
3106 bool disabled;
3107 int error;
3108 };
3109
3110 /**
3111 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3112 *
3113 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n)
3114 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT
3115 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3116 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3117 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3118 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3119 * request (connect callback).
3120 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE
3121 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT
3122 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3123 * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3124 * flag is not set.
3125 * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any)
3126 */
3127 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3128 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0),
3129 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1),
3130 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2),
3131 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3),
3132 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4),
3133 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5),
3134 CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6),
3135 ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(7),
3136 };
3137
3138 /**
3139 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3140 *
3141 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3142 * (re)association.
3143 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3144 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3145 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3146 * association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3147 * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3148 * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3149 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3150 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3151 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3152 * @crypto: crypto settings
3153 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3154 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3155 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3156 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3157 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3158 * frame.
3159 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3160 * @supported_selectors: supported selectors in IEEE 802.11 format
3161 * (or %NULL for no change).
3162 * If %NULL, then support for SAE_H2E should be assumed.
3163 * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets.
3164 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3165 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3166 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3167 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3168 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3169 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3170 * %NULL if FILS is not used.
3171 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3172 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3173 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3174 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3175 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3176 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3177 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3178 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3179 * the link on which the association request should be sent
3180 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3181 * valid iff @link_id >= 0
3182 */
3183 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3184 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3185 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3186 size_t ie_len;
3187 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3188 bool use_mfp;
3189 u32 flags;
3190 const u8 *supported_selectors;
3191 u8 supported_selectors_len;
3192 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3193 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3194 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3195 const u8 *fils_kek;
3196 size_t fils_kek_len;
3197 const u8 *fils_nonces;
3198 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3199 struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3200 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3201 s8 link_id;
3202
3203 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3204 };
3205
3206 /**
3207 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3208 *
3209 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3210 * deauthentication.
3211 *
3212 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3213 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3214 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3215 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3216 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3217 * do not set a deauth frame
3218 */
3219 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3220 const u8 *bssid;
3221 const u8 *ie;
3222 size_t ie_len;
3223 u16 reason_code;
3224 bool local_state_change;
3225 };
3226
3227 /**
3228 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3229 *
3230 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3231 * disassociation.
3232 *
3233 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3234 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3235 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3236 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3237 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3238 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3239 */
3240 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3241 const u8 *ap_addr;
3242 const u8 *ie;
3243 size_t ie_len;
3244 u16 reason_code;
3245 bool local_state_change;
3246 };
3247
3248 /**
3249 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3250 *
3251 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3252 * method.
3253 *
3254 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3255 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3256 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3257 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3258 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3259 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3260 * IBSSs to join on other channels.
3261 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3262 * @ie_len: length of that
3263 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3264 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3265 * after joining
3266 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3267 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3268 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3269 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3270 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3271 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3272 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3273 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3274 * to operate on DFS channels.
3275 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3276 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3277 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3278 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3279 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3280 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3281 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3282 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3283 */
3284 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3285 const u8 *ssid;
3286 const u8 *bssid;
3287 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3288 const u8 *ie;
3289 u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3290 u16 beacon_interval;
3291 u32 basic_rates;
3292 bool channel_fixed;
3293 bool privacy;
3294 bool control_port;
3295 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3296 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3297 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3298 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3299 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3300 struct key_params *wep_keys;
3301 int wep_tx_key;
3302
3303 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3304 };
3305
3306 /**
3307 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3308 *
3309 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3310 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3311 * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3312 * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3313 */
3314 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3315 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3316 union {
3317 enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3318 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3319 } param;
3320 };
3321
3322 /**
3323 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3324 *
3325 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3326 * authentication and association.
3327 *
3328 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3329 * on scan results)
3330 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3331 * %NULL if not specified
3332 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3333 * results)
3334 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3335 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3336 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3337 * to use.
3338 * @ssid: SSID
3339 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3340 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3341 * @ie: IEs for association request
3342 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3343 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3344 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3345 * @crypto: crypto settings
3346 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3347 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3348 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3349 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3350 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds
3351 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3352 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3353 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3354 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3355 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides
3356 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3357 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3358 * networks.
3359 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3360 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3361 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3362 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3363 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3364 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3365 * frame.
3366 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3367 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3368 * data IE.
3369 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3370 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3371 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3372 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3373 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3374 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3375 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3376 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3377 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3378 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3379 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3380 * offload of 4-way handshake.
3381 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3382 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3383 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3384 */
3385 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3386 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3387 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3388 const u8 *bssid;
3389 const u8 *bssid_hint;
3390 const u8 *ssid;
3391 size_t ssid_len;
3392 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3393 const u8 *ie;
3394 size_t ie_len;
3395 bool privacy;
3396 enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3397 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3398 const u8 *key;
3399 u8 key_len, key_idx;
3400 u32 flags;
3401 int bg_scan_period;
3402 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3403 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3404 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3405 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3406 bool pbss;
3407 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3408 const u8 *prev_bssid;
3409 const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3410 size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3411 const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3412 size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3413 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3414 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3415 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3416 bool want_1x;
3417 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3418
3419 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3420 };
3421
3422 /**
3423 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3424 *
3425 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3426 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3427 *
3428 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3429 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3430 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3431 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3432 */
3433 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3434 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0),
3435 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1),
3436 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2),
3437 };
3438
3439 /**
3440 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3441 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3442 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3443 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3444 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3445 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3446 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3447 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3448 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3449 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3450 */
3451 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3452 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = BIT(0),
3453 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = BIT(1),
3454 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = BIT(2),
3455 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = BIT(3),
3456 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = BIT(4),
3457 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = BIT(5),
3458 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = BIT(6),
3459 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = BIT(7),
3460 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = BIT(8),
3461 };
3462
3463 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256
3464
3465 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3466 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000
3467 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000
3468
3469 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3470 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000
3471
3472 /**
3473 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3474 *
3475 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3476 * caching.
3477 *
3478 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3479 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3480 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3481 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3482 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3483 * the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3484 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3485 * cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3486 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3487 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3488 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3489 * %NULL).
3490 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3491 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3492 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3493 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3494 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3495 * used for it expires.
3496 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3497 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3498 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3499 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3500 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3501 */
3502 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3503 const u8 *bssid;
3504 const u8 *pmkid;
3505 const u8 *pmk;
3506 size_t pmk_len;
3507 const u8 *ssid;
3508 size_t ssid_len;
3509 const u8 *cache_id;
3510 u32 pmk_lifetime;
3511 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3512 };
3513
3514 /**
3515 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3516 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3517 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3518 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3519 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3520 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3521 *
3522 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3523 * memory, free @mask only!
3524 */
3525 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3526 const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3527 int pattern_len;
3528 int pkt_offset;
3529 };
3530
3531 /**
3532 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3533 *
3534 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3535 * @src: source IP address
3536 * @dst: destination IP address
3537 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3538 * @src_port: source port
3539 * @dst_port: destination port
3540 * @payload_len: data payload length
3541 * @payload: data payload buffer
3542 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3543 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3544 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3545 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3546 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3547 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3548 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3549 */
3550 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3551 struct socket *sock;
3552 __be32 src, dst;
3553 u16 src_port, dst_port;
3554 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3555 int payload_len;
3556 const u8 *payload;
3557 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3558 u32 data_interval;
3559 u32 wake_len;
3560 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3561 u32 tokens_size;
3562 /* must be last, variable member */
3563 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3564 };
3565
3566 /**
3567 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3568 *
3569 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3570 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3571 * operating as normal during suspend
3572 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3573 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3574 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3575 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3576 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3577 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3578 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3579 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3580 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3581 * NULL if not configured.
3582 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3583 */
3584 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3585 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3586 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3587 rfkill_release;
3588 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3589 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3590 int n_patterns;
3591 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3592 };
3593
3594 /**
3595 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3596 *
3597 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3598 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3599 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3600 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3601 * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3602 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3603 */
3604 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3605 int delay;
3606 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3607 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3608 int n_patterns;
3609 };
3610
3611 /**
3612 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3613 *
3614 * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3615 * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3616 * @n_rules: number of rules
3617 */
3618 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3619 int n_rules;
3620 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules rules[] __counted_by(n_rules);
3621 };
3622
3623 /**
3624 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3625 *
3626 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3627 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This
3628 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3629 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3630 * occurred (in MHz)
3631 */
3632 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3633 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3634 int n_channels;
3635 u32 channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
3636 };
3637
3638 /**
3639 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3640 *
3641 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3642 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3643 * match information.
3644 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3645 * the matches that triggered the wake up.
3646 */
3647 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3648 int n_matches;
3649 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[] __counted_by(n_matches);
3650 };
3651
3652 /**
3653 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3654 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3655 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3656 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3657 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3658 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3659 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3660 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3661 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3662 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3663 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3664 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3665 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3666 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3667 * it is.
3668 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3669 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3670 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3671 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3672 * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or
3673 * disassoc frame (in MFP).
3674 */
3675 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3676 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3677 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3678 rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3679 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens,
3680 unprot_deauth_disassoc;
3681 s32 pattern_idx;
3682 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3683 const void *packet;
3684 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3685 };
3686
3687 /**
3688 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3689 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3690 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3691 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3692 * @kek_len: length of kek
3693 * @kck_len: length of kck
3694 * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3695 */
3696 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3697 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3698 u32 akm;
3699 u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3700 };
3701
3702 /**
3703 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3704 *
3705 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3706 *
3707 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3708 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3709 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3710 */
3711 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3712 u16 md;
3713 const u8 *ie;
3714 size_t ie_len;
3715 };
3716
3717 /**
3718 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3719 *
3720 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3721 *
3722 * @chan: channel to use
3723 * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3724 * @wait: duration for ROC
3725 * @buf: buffer to transmit
3726 * @len: buffer length
3727 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3728 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3729 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3730 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3731 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3732 * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3733 * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3734 */
3735 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3736 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3737 bool offchan;
3738 unsigned int wait;
3739 const u8 *buf;
3740 size_t len;
3741 bool no_cck;
3742 bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3743 int n_csa_offsets;
3744 const u16 *csa_offsets;
3745 int link_id;
3746 };
3747
3748 /**
3749 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3750 *
3751 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3752 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3753 */
3754 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3755 u8 dscp;
3756 u8 up;
3757 };
3758
3759 /**
3760 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3761 *
3762 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3763 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3764 */
3765 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3766 u8 low;
3767 u8 high;
3768 };
3769
3770 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3771 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21
3772 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16
3773 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3774 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3775
3776 /**
3777 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3778 *
3779 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3780 *
3781 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3782 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3783 * the user priority DSCP range definition
3784 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3785 */
3786 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3787 u8 num_des;
3788 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3789 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3790 };
3791
3792 /**
3793 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3794 *
3795 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3796 *
3797 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3798 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3799 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3800 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3801 */
3802 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3803 u8 master_pref;
3804 u8 bands;
3805 };
3806
3807 /**
3808 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3809 * configuration
3810 *
3811 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3812 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3813 */
3814 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3815 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3816 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3817 };
3818
3819 /**
3820 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3821 *
3822 * @filter: the content of the filter
3823 * @len: the length of the filter
3824 */
3825 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3826 const u8 *filter;
3827 u8 len;
3828 };
3829
3830 /**
3831 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3832 *
3833 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3834 * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3835 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3836 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3837 * implementation specific.
3838 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3839 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3840 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3841 * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3842 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3843 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3844 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3845 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3846 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3847 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3848 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3849 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3850 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3851 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3852 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3853 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3854 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3855 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3856 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3857 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3858 */
3859 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3860 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3861 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3862 u8 publish_type;
3863 bool close_range;
3864 bool publish_bcast;
3865 bool subscribe_active;
3866 u8 followup_id;
3867 u8 followup_reqid;
3868 struct mac_address followup_dest;
3869 u32 ttl;
3870 const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3871 u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3872 bool srf_include;
3873 const u8 *srf_bf;
3874 u8 srf_bf_len;
3875 u8 srf_bf_idx;
3876 struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3877 int srf_num_macs;
3878 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3879 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3880 u8 num_tx_filters;
3881 u8 num_rx_filters;
3882 u8 instance_id;
3883 u64 cookie;
3884
3885 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3886 };
3887
3888 /**
3889 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3890 *
3891 * @aa: authenticator address
3892 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3893 * @pmk: the PMK material
3894 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3895 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3896 * holds PMK-R0.
3897 */
3898 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3899 const u8 *aa;
3900 u8 pmk_len;
3901 const u8 *pmk;
3902 const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3903 };
3904
3905 /**
3906 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3907 *
3908 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3909 *
3910 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3911 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3912 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3913 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3914 * authentication response command interface.
3915 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and
3916 * authentication response command interface.
3917 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3918 * authentication request event interface.
3919 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3920 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3921 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3922 * response command interface (user space to driver).
3923 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3924 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3925 * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3926 * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3927 * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3928 * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3929 * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3930 * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3931 * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3932 * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3933 * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3934 * chosen for the authentication.
3935 */
3936 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3937 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3938 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3939 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3940 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3941 u16 status;
3942 const u8 *pmkid;
3943 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3944 };
3945
3946 /**
3947 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3948 *
3949 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3950 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3951 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3952 * answered
3953 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3954 * successfully answered
3955 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3956 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3957 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions
3958 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3959 * of how much time the responder was busy
3960 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3961 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3962 * the responder
3963 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3964 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3965 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3966 */
3967 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3968 u32 filled;
3969 u32 success_num;
3970 u32 partial_num;
3971 u32 failed_num;
3972 u32 asap_num;
3973 u32 non_asap_num;
3974 u64 total_duration_ms;
3975 u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3976 u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3977 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3978 };
3979
3980 /**
3981 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3982 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3983 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3984 * reason than just "failure"
3985 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3986 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3987 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3988 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3989 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3990 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3991 * by the responder
3992 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3993 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3994 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3995 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3996 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3997 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3998 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3999 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
4000 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
4001 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
4002 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
4003 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
4004 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
4005 * the square root of the variance)
4006 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
4007 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
4008 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg)
4009 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
4010 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
4011 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
4012 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
4013 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
4014 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
4015 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
4016 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
4017 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
4018 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
4019 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
4020 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
4021 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
4022 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
4023 */
4024 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
4025 const u8 *lci;
4026 const u8 *civicloc;
4027 unsigned int lci_len;
4028 unsigned int civicloc_len;
4029 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
4030 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
4031 s16 burst_index;
4032 u8 busy_retry_time;
4033 u8 num_bursts_exp;
4034 u8 burst_duration;
4035 u8 ftms_per_burst;
4036 s32 rssi_avg;
4037 s32 rssi_spread;
4038 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
4039 s64 rtt_avg;
4040 s64 rtt_variance;
4041 s64 rtt_spread;
4042 s64 dist_avg;
4043 s64 dist_variance;
4044 s64 dist_spread;
4045
4046 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
4047 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
4048 rssi_avg_valid:1,
4049 rssi_spread_valid:1,
4050 tx_rate_valid:1,
4051 rx_rate_valid:1,
4052 rtt_avg_valid:1,
4053 rtt_variance_valid:1,
4054 rtt_spread_valid:1,
4055 dist_avg_valid:1,
4056 dist_variance_valid:1,
4057 dist_spread_valid:1;
4058
4059 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
4060 };
4061
4062 /**
4063 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
4064 * @addr: address of the peer
4065 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
4066 * measurement was made)
4067 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
4068 * @status: status of the measurement
4069 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
4070 * reporting partial results always set this flag
4071 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
4072 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
4073 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
4074 * they're all aggregated for userspace.
4075 * @ftm: FTM result
4076 */
4077 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
4078 u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
4079 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4080
4081 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4082
4083 u8 final:1,
4084 ap_tsf_valid:1;
4085
4086 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4087
4088 union {
4089 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4090 };
4091 };
4092
4093 /**
4094 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4095 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4096 * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4097 * @burst_period: burst period to use
4098 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4099 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4100 * @burst_duration: burst duration
4101 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4102 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4103 * @request_lci: request LCI information
4104 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4105 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4106 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4107 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
4108 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4109 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4110 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
4111 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4112 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4113 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4114 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4115 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4116 *
4117 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4118 */
4119 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4120 enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4121 u16 burst_period;
4122 u8 requested:1,
4123 asap:1,
4124 request_lci:1,
4125 request_civicloc:1,
4126 trigger_based:1,
4127 non_trigger_based:1,
4128 lmr_feedback:1;
4129 u8 num_bursts_exp;
4130 u8 burst_duration;
4131 u8 ftms_per_burst;
4132 u8 ftmr_retries;
4133 u8 bss_color;
4134 };
4135
4136 /**
4137 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4138 * @addr: MAC address
4139 * @chandef: channel to use
4140 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4141 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4142 */
4143 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4144 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4145 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4146 u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4147 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4148 };
4149
4150 /**
4151 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4152 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4153 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4154 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4155 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4156 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4157 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4158 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4159 * be taken from the @mac_addr
4160 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4161 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4162 * zero it means there's no timeout
4163 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4164 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4165 */
4166 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4167 u64 cookie;
4168 void *drv_data;
4169 u32 n_peers;
4170 u32 nl_portid;
4171
4172 u32 timeout;
4173
4174 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4175 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4176
4177 struct list_head list;
4178
4179 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4180 };
4181
4182 /**
4183 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4184 *
4185 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4186 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4187 *
4188 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4189 *
4190 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4191 * has to be done.
4192 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4193 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4194 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4195 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4196 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4197 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4198 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4199 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4200 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4201 * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4202 * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4203 * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4204 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4205 * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4206 * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4207 * with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4208 */
4209 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4210 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4211 u16 status;
4212 const u8 *ie;
4213 size_t ie_len;
4214 int assoc_link_id;
4215 u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4216 };
4217
4218 /**
4219 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4220 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4221 * for the entire device
4222 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4223 * for the given interface
4224 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4225 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4226 * for these subtypes
4227 */
4228 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4229 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4230 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4231 };
4232
4233 /**
4234 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4235 *
4236 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4237 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4238 *
4239 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4240 * on success or a negative error code.
4241 *
4242 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4243 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4244 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4245 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4246 *
4247 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4248 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4249 * configured for the device.
4250 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4251 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4252 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4253 * the device.
4254 *
4255 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4256 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4257 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4258 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4259 * also set the address member in the wdev.
4260 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4261 *
4262 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4263 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4264 *
4265 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4266 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4267 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4268 *
4269 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4270 * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4271 * address is available.
4272 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4273 *
4274 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4275 * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4276 * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4277 * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4278 *
4279 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4280 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4281 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4282 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4283 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4284 * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4285 * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4286 * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4287 *
4288 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4289 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4290 * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4291 * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4292 * address for MLO pairwise key.
4293 *
4294 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4295 * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4296 *
4297 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4298 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4299 *
4300 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4301 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4302 *
4303 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4304 *
4305 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4306 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4307 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4308 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4309 *
4310 * @add_station: Add a new station.
4311 * @del_station: Remove a station
4312 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4313 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4314 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4315 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4316 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4317 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4318 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4319 *
4320 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4321 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4322 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4323 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4324 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4325 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4326 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4327 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4328 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4329 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4330 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4331 *
4332 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4333 *
4334 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4335 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4336 * set, and which to leave alone.
4337 *
4338 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4339 *
4340 * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4341 * for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4342 * from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4343 * The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4344 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4345 * The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4346 *
4347 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4348 *
4349 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4350 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4351 * join the mesh instead.
4352 *
4353 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4354 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4355 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4356 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4357 *
4358 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4359 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4360 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4361 * the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4362 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4363 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4364 *
4365 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4366 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4367 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4368 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4369 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4370 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4371 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4372 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4373 *
4374 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4375 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4376 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4377 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4378 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4379 * was received.
4380 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4381 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4382 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4383 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4384 * frame instead of Association Request frame.
4385 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4386 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4387 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4388 * indication of requesting reassociation.
4389 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4390 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4391 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4392 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4393 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4394 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4395 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4396 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4397 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4398 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4399 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4400 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4401 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4402 * case connection was already established (invoked with the
4403 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4404 *
4405 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4406 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4407 * to a merge.
4408 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4409 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4410 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4411 *
4412 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4413 * MESH mode)
4414 *
4415 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4416 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4417 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4418 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4419 *
4420 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4421 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4422 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4423 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4424 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4425 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4426 * return 0 if successful
4427 *
4428 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4429 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4430 *
4431 * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4432 *
4433 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4434 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4435 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4436 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4437 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4438 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4439 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4440 * the duration value.
4441 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4442 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4443 * frame on another channel
4444 *
4445 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4446 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4447 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4448 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4449 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4450 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4451 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4452 *
4453 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4454 *
4455 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4456 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4457 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4458 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4459 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4460 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4461 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4462 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4463 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4464 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4465 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4466 * disabled.)
4467 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4468 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the
4469 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should
4470 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4471 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4472 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4473 * thresholds.
4474 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4475 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4476 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4477 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4478 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4479 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4480 * stop (when this method returns 0).
4481 *
4482 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4483 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4484 *
4485 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4486 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4487 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4488 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4489 *
4490 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4491 *
4492 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4493 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4494 *
4495 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4496 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4497 *
4498 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4499 *
4500 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4501 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4502 * current monitoring channel.
4503 *
4504 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4505 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4506 *
4507 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4508 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4509 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4510 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4511 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4512 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4513 *
4514 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4515 *
4516 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4517 * was finished on another phy.
4518 *
4519 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4520 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4521 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4522 *
4523 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4524 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4525 * driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4526 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4527 * reliability. This operation can not fail.
4528 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4529 *
4530 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4531 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4532 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4533 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4534 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4535 * as soon as possible.
4536 *
4537 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4538 *
4539 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4540 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4541 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4542 *
4543 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4544 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4545 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4546 * account.
4547 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4548 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4549 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4550 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4551 * rejected)
4552 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4553 *
4554 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4555 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4556 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4557 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4558 *
4559 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4560 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4561 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4562 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4563 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4564 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4565 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4566 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4567 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4568 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4569 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4570 * cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4571 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4572 * provided @nan_func.
4573 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4574 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4575 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4576 * All other parameters must be ignored.
4577 *
4578 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4579 *
4580 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4581 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4582 *
4583 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4584 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4585 * upon which the driver should clear it.
4586 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4587 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4588 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4589 *
4590 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4591 * user space
4592 *
4593 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter
4594 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4595 *
4596 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4597 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4598 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4599 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4600 *
4601 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4602 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4603 * DH IE through this interface.
4604 *
4605 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4606 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4607 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4608 * This callback may sleep.
4609 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4610 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4611 *
4612 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4613 *
4614 * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4615 *
4616 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4617 * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4618 * Response frame.
4619 *
4620 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4621 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4622 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4623 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4624 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4625 * radar channel.
4626 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4627 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4628 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4629 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4630 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4631 *
4632 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4633 * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4634 * @get_radio_mask: get bitmask of radios in use.
4635 * (invoked with the wiphy mutex held)
4636 * @assoc_ml_reconf: Request a non-AP MLO connection to perform ML
4637 * reconfiguration, i.e., add and/or remove links to/from the
4638 * association using ML reconfiguration action frames. Successfully added
4639 * links will be added to the set of valid links. Successfully removed
4640 * links will be removed from the set of valid links. The driver must
4641 * indicate removed links by calling cfg80211_links_removed() and added
4642 * links by calling cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(). When calling
4643 * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done() the bss pointer must be given for each
4644 * link for which MLO reconfiguration 'add' operation was requested.
4645 */
4646 struct cfg80211_ops {
4647 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4648 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4649 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4650
4651 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4652 const char *name,
4653 unsigned char name_assign_type,
4654 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4655 struct vif_params *params);
4656 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4657 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4658 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4659 struct net_device *dev,
4660 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4661 struct vif_params *params);
4662
4663 int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4664 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4665 unsigned int link_id);
4666 void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4667 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4668 unsigned int link_id);
4669
4670 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4671 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4672 const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4673 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4674 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4675 const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4676 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4677 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4678 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4679 const u8 *mac_addr);
4680 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4681 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4682 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4683 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4684 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4685 u8 key_index);
4686 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4687 struct net_device *netdev,
4688 int link_id,
4689 u8 key_index);
4690
4691 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4692 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4693 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4694 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4695 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4696 unsigned int link_id);
4697
4698
4699 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4700 const u8 *mac,
4701 struct station_parameters *params);
4702 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4703 struct station_del_parameters *params);
4704 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4705 const u8 *mac,
4706 struct station_parameters *params);
4707 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4708 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4709 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4710 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4711
4712 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4713 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4714 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4715 const u8 *dst);
4716 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4717 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4718 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4719 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4720 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4721 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4722 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4723 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4724 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4725 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4726 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4727 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4728 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4729 struct net_device *dev,
4730 struct mesh_config *conf);
4731 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4732 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4733 const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4734 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4735 const struct mesh_config *conf,
4736 const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4737 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4738
4739 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4740 struct ocb_setup *setup);
4741 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4742
4743 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4744 struct bss_parameters *params);
4745
4746 void (*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4747 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4748
4749 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4750 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4751
4752 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4753 struct net_device *dev,
4754 struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4755
4756 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4757 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4758
4759 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4760 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4761 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4762
4763 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4764 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4765 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4766 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4767 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4768 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4769 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4770 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4771
4772 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4773 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4774 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4775 struct net_device *dev,
4776 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4777 u32 changed);
4778 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4779 u16 reason_code);
4780
4781 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4782 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4783 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4784
4785 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4786 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4787
4788 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4789
4790 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4791 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4792 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4793 int *dbm);
4794
4795 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4796
4797 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4798 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4799 void *data, int len);
4800 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4801 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4802 void *data, int len);
4803 #endif
4804
4805 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4806 struct net_device *dev,
4807 unsigned int link_id,
4808 const u8 *peer,
4809 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4810
4811 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4812 int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4813
4814 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4815 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4816 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4817 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4818 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4819
4820 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4821 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4822 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4823 unsigned int duration,
4824 u64 *cookie);
4825 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4826 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4827 u64 cookie);
4828
4829 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4830 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4831 u64 *cookie);
4832 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4833 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4834 u64 cookie);
4835
4836 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4837 bool enabled, int timeout);
4838
4839 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4840 struct net_device *dev,
4841 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4842
4843 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4844 struct net_device *dev,
4845 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4846
4847 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4848 struct net_device *dev,
4849 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4850
4851 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4852 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4853 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4854
4855 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4856 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4857
4858 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4859 struct net_device *dev,
4860 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4861 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4862 u64 reqid);
4863
4864 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4865 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4866
4867 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4868 const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4869 u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4870 u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4871 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4872 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4873 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4874
4875 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4876 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4877
4878 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4879 struct net_device *dev,
4880 u16 noack_map);
4881
4882 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4883 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4884 unsigned int link_id,
4885 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4886
4887 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4888 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4889 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4890 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4891
4892 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4893 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4894
4895 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4896 struct net_device *dev,
4897 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4898 u32 cac_time_ms, int link_id);
4899 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4900 struct net_device *dev, unsigned int link_id);
4901 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4902 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4903 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4904 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4905 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4906 u16 duration);
4907 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4908 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4909 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4910 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4911
4912 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4913 struct net_device *dev,
4914 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4915
4916 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4917 struct net_device *dev,
4918 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4919
4920 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4921 unsigned int link_id,
4922 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4923
4924 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4925 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4926 u16 admitted_time);
4927 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4928 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4929
4930 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4931 struct net_device *dev,
4932 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4933 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4934 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4935 struct net_device *dev,
4936 const u8 *addr);
4937 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4938 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4939 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4940 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4941 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4942 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4943 u64 cookie);
4944 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4945 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4946 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4947 u32 changes);
4948
4949 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4950 struct net_device *dev,
4951 const bool enabled);
4952
4953 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4954 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4955 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4956
4957 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4958 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4959 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4960 const u8 *aa);
4961 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4962 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4963
4964 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4965 struct net_device *dev,
4966 const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4967 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4968 const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4969 u64 *cookie);
4970
4971 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4972 struct net_device *dev,
4973 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4974
4975 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4976 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4977 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4978 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4979 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4980 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4981 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4982 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4983 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4984 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4985 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4986 const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4987 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4988 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4989 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4990 struct net_device *dev,
4991 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4992 int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4993 struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4994 int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4995 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4996 int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4997 struct link_station_parameters *params);
4998 int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4999 struct link_station_parameters *params);
5000 int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5001 struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
5002 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5003 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
5004 int (*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5005 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
5006 u32 (*get_radio_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
5007 int (*assoc_ml_reconf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5008 struct cfg80211_assoc_link *add_links,
5009 u16 rem_links);
5010
5011 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5012 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
5013 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
5014 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
5015 };
5016
5017 /*
5018 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
5019 * and registration/helper functions
5020 */
5021
5022 /**
5023 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
5024 *
5025 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
5026 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz.
5027 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
5028 * wiphy at all
5029 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
5030 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
5031 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
5032 * reason to override the default
5033 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
5034 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
5035 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
5036 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
5037 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
5038 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
5039 * control_port_no_encrypt flag.
5040 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
5041 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
5042 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
5043 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
5044 * firmware.
5045 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
5046 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
5047 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
5048 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
5049 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
5050 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
5051 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
5052 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
5053 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
5054 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
5055 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
5056 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
5057 * responds to probe-requests in hardware.
5058 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
5059 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
5060 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
5061 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
5062 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
5063 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
5064 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
5065 * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
5066 * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
5067 * should set this flag for now.
5068 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
5069 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
5070 * NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
5071 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
5072 * set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
5073 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
5074 * of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
5075 * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device
5076 */
5077 enum wiphy_flags {
5078 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0),
5079 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1),
5080 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2),
5081 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3),
5082 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4),
5083 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5),
5084 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6),
5085 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7),
5086 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8),
5087 WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT = BIT(9),
5088 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10),
5089 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11),
5090 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY = BIT(12),
5091 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13),
5092 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14),
5093 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15),
5094 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16),
5095 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17),
5096 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18),
5097 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19),
5098 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20),
5099 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21),
5100 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22),
5101 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23),
5102 WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER = BIT(24),
5103 WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON = BIT(25),
5104 };
5105
5106 /**
5107 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5108 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5109 * @types: interface types (bits)
5110 */
5111 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5112 u16 max;
5113 u16 types;
5114 };
5115
5116 /**
5117 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5118 *
5119 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5120 * combinations it supports concurrently. When set in a struct wiphy_radio,
5121 * the combinations refer to combinations of interfaces currently active on
5122 * that radio.
5123 *
5124 * Examples:
5125 *
5126 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5127 *
5128 * .. code-block:: c
5129 *
5130 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5131 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5132 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5133 * };
5134 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5135 * .limits = limits1,
5136 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5137 * .max_interfaces = 2,
5138 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5139 * };
5140 *
5141 *
5142 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5143 *
5144 * .. code-block:: c
5145 *
5146 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5147 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5148 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5149 * };
5150 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5151 * .limits = limits2,
5152 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5153 * .max_interfaces = 8,
5154 * .num_different_channels = 1,
5155 * };
5156 *
5157 *
5158 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5159 *
5160 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5161 *
5162 * .. code-block:: c
5163 *
5164 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5165 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5166 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5167 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5168 * };
5169 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5170 * .limits = limits3,
5171 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5172 * .max_interfaces = 4,
5173 * .num_different_channels = 2,
5174 * };
5175 *
5176 */
5177 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5178 /**
5179 * @limits:
5180 * limits for the given interface types
5181 */
5182 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5183
5184 /**
5185 * @num_different_channels:
5186 * can use up to this many different channels
5187 */
5188 u32 num_different_channels;
5189
5190 /**
5191 * @max_interfaces:
5192 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5193 */
5194 u16 max_interfaces;
5195
5196 /**
5197 * @n_limits:
5198 * number of limitations
5199 */
5200 u8 n_limits;
5201
5202 /**
5203 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5204 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5205 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5206 */
5207 bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5208
5209 /**
5210 * @radar_detect_widths:
5211 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5212 */
5213 u8 radar_detect_widths;
5214
5215 /**
5216 * @radar_detect_regions:
5217 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5218 */
5219 u8 radar_detect_regions;
5220
5221 /**
5222 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5223 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5224 *
5225 * = 0
5226 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5227 * > 0
5228 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5229 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5230 * combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5231 */
5232 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5233 };
5234
5235 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5236 u16 tx, rx;
5237 };
5238
5239 /**
5240 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5241 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5242 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5243 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5244 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5245 * packet should be preserved in that case
5246 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5247 * (see nl80211.h)
5248 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5249 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5250 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5251 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5252 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5253 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5254 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5255 */
5256 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5257 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0),
5258 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1),
5259 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2),
5260 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3),
5261 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4),
5262 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5),
5263 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6),
5264 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7),
5265 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8),
5266 };
5267
5268 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5269 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5270 u32 data_payload_max;
5271 u32 data_interval_max;
5272 u32 wake_payload_max;
5273 bool seq;
5274 };
5275
5276 /**
5277 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5278 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5279 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5280 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5281 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5282 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5283 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5284 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5285 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5286 * scheduled scans.
5287 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5288 * details.
5289 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5290 */
5291 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5292 u32 flags;
5293 int n_patterns;
5294 int pattern_max_len;
5295 int pattern_min_len;
5296 int max_pkt_offset;
5297 int max_nd_match_sets;
5298 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5299 };
5300
5301 /**
5302 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5303 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5304 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5305 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5306 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5307 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5308 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5309 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5310 */
5311 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5312 int n_rules;
5313 int max_delay;
5314 int n_patterns;
5315 int pattern_max_len;
5316 int pattern_min_len;
5317 int max_pkt_offset;
5318 };
5319
5320 /**
5321 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5322 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5323 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5324 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5325 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5326 */
5327 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5328 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5329 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5330 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5331 };
5332
5333 /**
5334 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5335 *
5336 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5337 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5338 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5339 *
5340 */
5341 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5342 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
5343 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1),
5344 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2),
5345 };
5346
5347 /**
5348 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5349 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5350 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5351 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5352 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5353 */
5354
5355 struct sta_opmode_info {
5356 u32 changed;
5357 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5358 enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5359 u8 rx_nss;
5360 };
5361
5362 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5363
5364 /**
5365 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5366 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5367 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5368 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5369 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5370 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5371 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5372 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5373 * dumpit calls.
5374 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5375 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5376 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5377 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5378 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5379 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5380 * are used with dump requests.
5381 */
5382 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5383 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5384 u32 flags;
5385 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5386 const void *data, int data_len);
5387 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5388 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5389 unsigned long *storage);
5390 const struct nla_policy *policy;
5391 unsigned int maxattr;
5392
5393 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5394 };
5395
5396 /**
5397 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5398 * @iftype: interface type
5399 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5400 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5401 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5402 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5403 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5404 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5405 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5406 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5407 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5408 */
5409 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5410 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5411 const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5412 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5413 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5414 u16 eml_capabilities;
5415 u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5416 };
5417
5418 /**
5419 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5420 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5421 * @type: the interface type to look up
5422 *
5423 * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL
5424 */
5425 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5426 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5427
5428 /**
5429 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5430 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5431 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5432 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5433 * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5434 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5435 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5436 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5437 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5438 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5439 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5440 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5441 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5442 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5443 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5444 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5445 * not limited)
5446 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5447 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5448 */
5449 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5450 unsigned int max_peers;
5451 u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5452 randomize_mac_addr:1;
5453
5454 struct {
5455 u32 preambles;
5456 u32 bandwidths;
5457 s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5458 u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5459 u8 supported:1,
5460 asap:1,
5461 non_asap:1,
5462 request_lci:1,
5463 request_civicloc:1,
5464 trigger_based:1,
5465 non_trigger_based:1;
5466 } ftm;
5467 };
5468
5469 /**
5470 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5471 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5472 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5473 *
5474 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5475 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5476 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5477 */
5478 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5479 u16 iftypes_mask;
5480 const u32 *akm_suites;
5481 int n_akm_suites;
5482 };
5483
5484 /**
5485 * struct wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy frequency range
5486 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency (kHz)
5487 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency (kHz)
5488 */
5489 struct wiphy_radio_freq_range {
5490 u32 start_freq;
5491 u32 end_freq;
5492 };
5493
5494
5495 /**
5496 * struct wiphy_radio - physical radio of a wiphy
5497 * This structure describes a physical radio belonging to a wiphy.
5498 * It is used to describe concurrent-channel capabilities. Only one channel
5499 * can be active on the radio described by struct wiphy_radio.
5500 *
5501 * @freq_range: frequency range that the radio can operate on.
5502 * @n_freq_range: number of elements in @freq_range
5503 *
5504 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5505 * list single interface types.
5506 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5507 */
5508 struct wiphy_radio {
5509 const struct wiphy_radio_freq_range *freq_range;
5510 int n_freq_range;
5511
5512 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5513 int n_iface_combinations;
5514 };
5515
5516 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS 0xffff
5517
5518 /**
5519 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5520 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5521 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5522 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5523 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5524 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5525 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5526 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5527 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5528 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5529 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5530 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5531 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5532 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5533 * iftype_akm_suites.
5534 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5535 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5536 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5537 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5538 * instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5539 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5540 * suites are specified separately.
5541 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5542 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5543 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5544 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5545 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5546 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5547 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5548 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5549 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5550 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5551 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5552 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5553 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5554 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5555 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5556 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5557 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5558 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5559 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5560 * unregister hardware
5561 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5562 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5563 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5564 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5565 * (see below).
5566 * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5567 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5568 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5569 * must be set by driver
5570 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5571 * list single interface types.
5572 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5573 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5574 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5575 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5576 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5577 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5578 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5579 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5580 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5581 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5582 * this variable determines its size
5583 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5584 * any given scan
5585 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5586 * the device can run concurrently.
5587 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5588 * for in any given scheduled scan
5589 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5590 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5591 * supported.
5592 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5593 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5594 * include fixed IEs like supported rates
5595 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5596 * scans
5597 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5598 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5599 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5600 * single scan plan supported by the device.
5601 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5602 * scan plan supported by the device.
5603 * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5604 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5605 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5606 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5607 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5608 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5609 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5610 *
5611 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5612 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5613 * type
5614 *
5615 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5616 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5617 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5618 *
5619 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5620 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5621 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5622 *
5623 * @probe_resp_offload:
5624 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5625 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5626 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5627 *
5628 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5629 * may request, if implemented.
5630 *
5631 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5632 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5633 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5634 * to the suspend() operation instead.
5635 *
5636 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5637 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5638 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5639 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5640 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5641 *
5642 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5643 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5644 *
5645 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5646 * supports for ACL.
5647 *
5648 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5649 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5650 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5651 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5652 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5653 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5654 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5655 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5656 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5657 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5658 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5659 * capabilities are specified separately.
5660 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5661 *
5662 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5663 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5664 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5665 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5666 *
5667 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5668 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5669 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5670 * some cases, but may not always reach.
5671 *
5672 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5673 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver
5674 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5675 * infinite.
5676 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5677 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5678 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5679 *
5680 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5681 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for
5682 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5683 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5684 *
5685 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5686 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5687 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5688 *
5689 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5690 * wake_tx_queue
5691 *
5692 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5693 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5694 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5695 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5696 *
5697 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5698 *
5699 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5700 * device has
5701 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5702 * supported by the driver for each vif
5703 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5704 * supported by the driver for each peer
5705 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5706 * long/short retry configuration
5707 *
5708 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5709 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5710 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5711 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5712 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5713 *
5714 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5715 * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5716 * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5717 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5718 * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5719 * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5720 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5721 * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5722 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5723 * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5724 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5725 * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5726 * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5727 *
5728 * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5729 * enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5730 * non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5731 * A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5732 * supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5733 * specify a mac address).
5734 *
5735 * @radio: radios belonging to this wiphy
5736 * @n_radio: number of radios
5737 */
5738 struct wiphy {
5739 struct mutex mtx;
5740
5741 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5742
5743 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5744 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5745
5746 struct mac_address *addresses;
5747
5748 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5749
5750 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5751 int n_iface_combinations;
5752 u16 software_iftypes;
5753
5754 u16 n_addresses;
5755
5756 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5757 u16 interface_modes;
5758
5759 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5760
5761 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5762 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5763
5764 u32 ap_sme_capa;
5765
5766 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5767
5768 int bss_priv_size;
5769 u8 max_scan_ssids;
5770 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5771 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5772 u8 max_match_sets;
5773 u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5774 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5775 u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5776 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5777 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5778
5779 int n_cipher_suites;
5780 const u32 *cipher_suites;
5781
5782 int n_akm_suites;
5783 const u32 *akm_suites;
5784
5785 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5786 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5787
5788 u8 retry_short;
5789 u8 retry_long;
5790 u32 frag_threshold;
5791 u32 rts_threshold;
5792 u8 coverage_class;
5793
5794 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5795 u32 hw_version;
5796
5797 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5798 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5799 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5800 #endif
5801
5802 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5803
5804 u8 max_num_pmkids;
5805
5806 u32 available_antennas_tx;
5807 u32 available_antennas_rx;
5808
5809 u32 probe_resp_offload;
5810
5811 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5812 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5813
5814 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5815 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5816
5817 const void *privid;
5818
5819 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5820
5821 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5822 struct regulatory_request *request);
5823
5824 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5825
5826 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5827
5828 struct device dev;
5829
5830 bool registered;
5831
5832 struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5833
5834 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5835 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5836
5837 struct list_head wdev_list;
5838
5839 possible_net_t _net;
5840
5841 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5842 const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5843 #endif
5844
5845 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5846
5847 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5848 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5849 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5850
5851 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5852
5853 u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5854
5855 u32 bss_select_support;
5856
5857 u8 nan_supported_bands;
5858
5859 u32 txq_limit;
5860 u32 txq_memory_limit;
5861 u32 txq_quantum;
5862
5863 unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5864
5865 u8 support_mbssid:1,
5866 support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5867
5868 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5869
5870 struct {
5871 u64 peer, vif;
5872 u8 max_retry;
5873 } tid_config_support;
5874
5875 u8 max_data_retry_count;
5876
5877 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5878
5879 struct rfkill *rfkill;
5880
5881 u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5882 u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5883 u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5884
5885 u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5886
5887 int n_radio;
5888 const struct wiphy_radio *radio;
5889 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5890
5891 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5892 };
5893
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5894 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5895 {
5896 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5897 }
5898
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5899 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5900 {
5901 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5902 }
5903
5904 /**
5905 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5906 *
5907 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5908 * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5909 */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5910 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5911 {
5912 BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5913 return &wiphy->priv;
5914 }
5915
5916 /**
5917 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5918 *
5919 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5920 * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5921 */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5922 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5923 {
5924 BUG_ON(!priv);
5925 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5926 }
5927
5928 /**
5929 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5930 *
5931 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5932 * @dev: The device to parent it to
5933 */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5934 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5935 {
5936 wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5937 }
5938
5939 /**
5940 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5941 *
5942 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5943 * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5944 */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5945 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5946 {
5947 return wiphy->dev.parent;
5948 }
5949
5950 /**
5951 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5952 *
5953 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5954 * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5955 */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5956 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5957 {
5958 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5959 }
5960
5961 /**
5962 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5963 *
5964 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5965 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5966 * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5967 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5968 *
5969 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5970 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5971 *
5972 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5973 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5974 */
5975 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5976 const char *requested_name);
5977
5978 /**
5979 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5980 *
5981 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5982 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5983 *
5984 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5985 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5986 *
5987 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5988 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5989 */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5990 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5991 int sizeof_priv)
5992 {
5993 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5994 }
5995
5996 /**
5997 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5998 *
5999 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
6000 *
6001 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
6002 */
6003 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6004
6005 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
6006 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
6007
6008 /**
6009 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
6010 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
6011 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
6012 *
6013 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
6014 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
6015 */
6016 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \
6017 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
6018
6019 /**
6020 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
6021 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
6022 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
6023 *
6024 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
6025 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
6026 */
6027 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \
6028 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
6029
6030 /**
6031 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
6032 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
6033 *
6034 * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection.
6035 *
6036 * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy
6037 */
6038 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6039
6040 /**
6041 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
6042 *
6043 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
6044 *
6045 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
6046 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
6047 * request that is being handled.
6048 */
6049 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6050
6051 /**
6052 * wiphy_free - free wiphy
6053 *
6054 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
6055 */
6056 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6057
6058 /* internal structs */
6059 struct cfg80211_conn;
6060 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
6061 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
6062 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
6063
6064 /**
6065 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
6066 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
6067 *
6068 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
6069 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
6070 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
6071 * differentiate which way it's called.
6072 *
6073 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
6074 *
6075 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
6076 *
6077 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
6078 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
6079 */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6080 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6081 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
6082 {
6083 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
6084 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
6085 }
6086
6087 /**
6088 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
6089 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
6090 */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6091 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6092 __releases(&wiphy->mtx)
6093 {
6094 __release(&wiphy->mtx);
6095 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
6096 }
6097
6098 struct wiphy_work;
6099 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
6100
6101 struct wiphy_work {
6102 struct list_head entry;
6103 wiphy_work_func_t func;
6104 };
6105
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)6106 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
6107 wiphy_work_func_t func)
6108 {
6109 INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
6110 work->func = func;
6111 }
6112
6113 /**
6114 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
6115 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6116 * @work: the work item
6117 *
6118 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6119 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6120 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6121 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6122 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6123 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6124 */
6125 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6126
6127 /**
6128 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
6129 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6130 * @work: the work to cancel
6131 *
6132 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6133 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6134 */
6135 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6136
6137 /**
6138 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
6139 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6140 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
6141 *
6142 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6143 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6144 */
6145 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6146
6147 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
6148 struct wiphy_work work;
6149 struct wiphy *wiphy;
6150 struct timer_list timer;
6151 };
6152
6153 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6154
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)6155 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6156 wiphy_work_func_t func)
6157 {
6158 timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6159 wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6160 }
6161
6162 /**
6163 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6164 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6165 * @dwork: the delayable worker
6166 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6167 *
6168 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6169 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6170 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6171 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6172 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6173 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6174 */
6175 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6176 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6177 unsigned long delay);
6178
6179 /**
6180 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6181 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6182 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6183 *
6184 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6185 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6186 */
6187 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6188 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6189
6190 /**
6191 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6192 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6193 * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6194 *
6195 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6196 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6197 */
6198 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6199 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6200
6201 /**
6202 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending - Find out whether a wiphy delayable
6203 * work item is currently pending.
6204 *
6205 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6206 * @dwork: the delayed work in question
6207 *
6208 * Return: true if timer is pending, false otherwise
6209 *
6210 * How wiphy_delayed_work_queue() works is by setting a timer which
6211 * when it expires calls wiphy_work_queue() to queue the wiphy work.
6212 * Because wiphy_delayed_work_queue() uses mod_timer(), if it is
6213 * called twice and the second call happens before the first call
6214 * deadline, the work will rescheduled for the second deadline and
6215 * won't run before that.
6216 *
6217 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending() can be used to detect if calling
6218 * wiphy_work_delayed_work_queue() would start a new work schedule
6219 * or delayed a previous one. As seen below it cannot be used to
6220 * detect precisely if the work has finished to execute nor if it
6221 * is currently executing.
6222 *
6223 * CPU0 CPU1
6224 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue(wk)
6225 * mod_timer(wk->timer)
6226 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> true
6227 *
6228 * [...]
6229 * expire_timers(wk->timer)
6230 * detach_timer(wk->timer)
6231 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> false
6232 * wk->timer->function() |
6233 * wiphy_work_queue(wk) | delayed work pending
6234 * list_add_tail() | returns false but
6235 * queue_work(cfg80211_wiphy_work) | wk->func() has not
6236 * | been run yet
6237 * [...] |
6238 * cfg80211_wiphy_work() |
6239 * wk->func() V
6240 *
6241 */
6242 bool wiphy_delayed_work_pending(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6243 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6244
6245 /**
6246 * enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power - regulatory power for an Access Point
6247 *
6248 * @IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP: Access Point has no regulatory power mode
6249 * @IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP: Indoor Access Point
6250 * @IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP: Standard power Access Point
6251 * @IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP: Very low power Access Point
6252 */
6253 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power {
6254 IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP,
6255 IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP,
6256 IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP,
6257 IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP,
6258 };
6259
6260 /**
6261 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6262 *
6263 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6264 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6265 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6266 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6267 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6268 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6269 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6270 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6271 *
6272 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6273 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6274 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6275 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6276 *
6277 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6278 * @iftype: interface type
6279 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6280 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6281 * for the notifier
6282 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6283 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6284 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6285 * wireless device if it has no netdev
6286 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6287 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6288 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6289 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6290 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6291 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6292 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6293 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6294 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6295 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6296 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6297 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6298 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6299 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6300 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6301 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6302 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6303 * by cfg80211 on change_interface
6304 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6305 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6306 * need to propagate the update to the driver
6307 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6308 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6309 * the P2P Device.
6310 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6311 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6312 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6313 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6314 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6315 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6316 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6317 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6318 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6319 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6320 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6321 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6322 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6323 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6324 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6325 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6326 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6327 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6328 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6329 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6330 * unprotected beacon report
6331 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6332 * @ap and @client for each link
6333 * @links.cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been
6334 * started
6335 * @links.cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was
6336 * entered.
6337 * @links.cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6338 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6339 * @radio_mask: Bitmask of radios that this interface is allowed to operate on.
6340 */
6341 struct wireless_dev {
6342 struct wiphy *wiphy;
6343 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6344
6345 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6346 struct list_head list;
6347 struct net_device *netdev;
6348
6349 u32 identifier;
6350
6351 struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6352 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6353
6354 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6355
6356 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6357
6358 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6359 struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6360 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6361 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6362 u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6363
6364 struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6365 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6366
6367 struct list_head event_list;
6368 spinlock_t event_lock;
6369
6370 u8 connected:1;
6371
6372 bool ps;
6373 int ps_timeout;
6374
6375 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6376
6377 u32 owner_nlportid;
6378 bool nl_owner_dead;
6379
6380 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6381 /* wext data */
6382 struct {
6383 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6384 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6385 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6386 const u8 *ie;
6387 size_t ie_len;
6388 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6389 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6390 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6391 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6392 bool prev_bssid_valid;
6393 } wext;
6394 #endif
6395
6396 struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6397 struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6398
6399 struct list_head pmsr_list;
6400 spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6401 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6402
6403 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6404
6405 union {
6406 struct {
6407 u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6408 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6409 u8 ssid_len;
6410 } client;
6411 struct {
6412 int beacon_interval;
6413 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6414 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6415 u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN];
6416 u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6417 } mesh;
6418 struct {
6419 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6420 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6421 u8 ssid_len;
6422 } ap;
6423 struct {
6424 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6425 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6426 int beacon_interval;
6427 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6428 u8 ssid_len;
6429 } ibss;
6430 struct {
6431 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6432 } ocb;
6433 } u;
6434
6435 struct {
6436 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6437 union {
6438 struct {
6439 unsigned int beacon_interval;
6440 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6441 } ap;
6442 struct {
6443 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6444 } client;
6445 };
6446
6447 bool cac_started;
6448 unsigned long cac_start_time;
6449 unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6450 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6451 u16 valid_links;
6452
6453 u32 radio_mask;
6454 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
6455 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
6456 };
6457
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6458 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6459 {
6460 if (wdev->netdev)
6461 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6462 return wdev->address;
6463 }
6464
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6465 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6466 {
6467 if (wdev->netdev)
6468 return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6469 return wdev->is_running;
6470 }
6471
6472 /**
6473 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6474 *
6475 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6476 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6477 */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6478 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6479 {
6480 BUG_ON(!wdev);
6481 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6482 }
6483
6484 /**
6485 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6486 * @wdev: the wdev
6487 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6488 *
6489 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6490 */
6491 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6492 unsigned int link_id);
6493
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6494 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6495 unsigned int link_id)
6496 {
6497 WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6498 WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6499 !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6500 }
6501
6502 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \
6503 for (link_id = 0; \
6504 link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \
6505 ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \
6506 link_id++) \
6507 if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \
6508 ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6509
6510 /**
6511 * DOC: Utility functions
6512 *
6513 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6514 */
6515
6516 /**
6517 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6518 *
6519 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6520 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6521 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6522 */
6523 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6524 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6525 struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6526 {
6527 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6528 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6529 }
6530
6531 /**
6532 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6533 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6534 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6535 */
6536 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6537 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6538 {
6539 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6540 }
6541
6542 /**
6543 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6544 *
6545 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6546 * @chan: channel
6547 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6548 */
6549 enum nl80211_chan_width
6550 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6551
6552 /**
6553 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6554 * @chan: channel number
6555 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6556 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6557 */
6558 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6559
6560 /**
6561 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6562 * @chan: channel number
6563 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6564 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6565 */
6566 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6567 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6568 {
6569 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6570 }
6571
6572 /**
6573 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6574 * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6575 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6576 */
6577 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6578
6579 /**
6580 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6581 * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6582 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6583 */
6584 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6585 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6586 {
6587 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6588 }
6589
6590 /**
6591 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6592 * frequency
6593 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6594 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6595 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6596 */
6597 struct ieee80211_channel *
6598 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6599
6600 /**
6601 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6602 *
6603 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6604 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6605 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6606 */
6607 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6608 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6609 {
6610 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6611 }
6612
6613 /**
6614 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6615 * @chan: control channel to check
6616 *
6617 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6618 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6619 *
6620 * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise
6621 */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6622 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6623 {
6624 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6625 return false;
6626
6627 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6628 }
6629
6630 /**
6631 * cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid - Check if the radio supports the chandef
6632 *
6633 * @radio: wiphy radio
6634 * @chandef: chandef for current channel
6635 *
6636 * Return: whether or not the given chandef is valid for the given radio
6637 */
6638 bool cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid(const struct wiphy_radio *radio,
6639 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
6640
6641 /**
6642 * cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed - Check if the wdev may use the channel
6643 *
6644 * @wdev: the wireless device
6645 * @chan: channel to check
6646 *
6647 * Return: whether or not the wdev may use the channel
6648 */
6649 bool cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6650 struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6651
6652 /**
6653 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6654 *
6655 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6656 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6657 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6658 *
6659 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6660 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6661 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6662 * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6663 */
6664 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6665 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6666 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6667
6668 /**
6669 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6670 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6671 *
6672 * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits
6673 * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6674 */
6675 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6676
6677 /*
6678 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6679 *
6680 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6681 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6682 */
6683
6684 struct radiotap_align_size {
6685 uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6686 };
6687
6688 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6689 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6690 int n_bits;
6691 uint32_t oui;
6692 uint8_t subns;
6693 };
6694
6695 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6696 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6697 int n_ns;
6698 };
6699
6700 /**
6701 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6702 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6703 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6704 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6705 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6706 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6707 * the beginning of the actual data portion
6708 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6709 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6710 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6711 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6712 * radiotap namespace or not
6713 *
6714 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6715 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6716 * @_arg_index: next argument index
6717 * @_arg: next argument pointer
6718 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6719 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6720 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6721 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6722 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6723 * next bitmap word
6724 *
6725 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6726 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6727 */
6728
6729 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6730 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6731 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6732 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6733
6734 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6735 __le32 *_next_bitmap;
6736
6737 unsigned char *this_arg;
6738 int this_arg_index;
6739 int this_arg_size;
6740
6741 int is_radiotap_ns;
6742
6743 int _max_length;
6744 int _arg_index;
6745 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6746 int _reset_on_ext;
6747 };
6748
6749 int
6750 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6751 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6752 int max_length,
6753 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6754
6755 int
6756 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6757
6758
6759 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6760 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6761
6762 /**
6763 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6764 *
6765 * @skb: the frame
6766 *
6767 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6768 * returns the 802.11 header length.
6769 *
6770 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6771 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6772 * 802.11 header.
6773 */
6774 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6775
6776 /**
6777 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6778 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6779 * Return: The header length in bytes.
6780 */
6781 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6782
6783 /**
6784 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6785 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6786 * (first byte) will be accessed
6787 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6788 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6789 */
6790 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6791
6792 /**
6793 * DOC: Data path helpers
6794 *
6795 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6796 * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6797 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6798 */
6799
6800 /**
6801 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6802 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6803 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6804 * of it being pushed into the SKB
6805 * @addr: the device MAC address
6806 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6807 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6808 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6809 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6810 */
6811 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6812 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6813 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6814
6815 /**
6816 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6817 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6818 * @addr: the device MAC address
6819 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6820 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6821 */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6822 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6823 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6824 {
6825 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6826 }
6827
6828 /**
6829 * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6830 *
6831 * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6832 * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6833 * mesh control field.
6834 *
6835 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6836 * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6837 * 0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6838 * 1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6839 * 2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6840 * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6841 */
6842 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6843
6844 /**
6845 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6846 *
6847 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6848 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6849 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6850 *
6851 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6852 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6853 * initialized by the caller.
6854 * @addr: The device MAC address.
6855 * @iftype: The device interface type.
6856 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6857 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6858 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6859 * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6860 */
6861 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6862 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6863 const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6864 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6865 u8 mesh_control);
6866
6867 /**
6868 * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6869 *
6870 * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6871 * protocol.
6872 *
6873 * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6874 * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6875 * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6876 */
6877 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6878
6879 /**
6880 * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6881 *
6882 * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6883 * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6884 * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6885 *
6886 * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6887 *
6888 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6889 */
6890 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6891
6892 /**
6893 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6894 * @skb: the data frame
6895 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6896 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6897 */
6898 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6899 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6900
6901 /**
6902 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6903 *
6904 * @eid: element ID
6905 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6906 * @len: length of data
6907 * @match: byte array to match
6908 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6909 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6910 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6911 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6912 * the data portion instead.
6913 *
6914 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6915 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6916 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6917 * requested element struct.
6918 *
6919 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6920 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6921 * byte array to match.
6922 */
6923 const struct element *
6924 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6925 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6926 unsigned int match_offset);
6927
6928 /**
6929 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6930 *
6931 * @eid: element ID
6932 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6933 * @len: length of data
6934 * @match: byte array to match
6935 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6936 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6937 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6938 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6939 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6940 * the second byte is the IE length.
6941 *
6942 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6943 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6944 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6945 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6946 * element ID.
6947 *
6948 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6949 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6950 * byte array to match.
6951 */
6952 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6953 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6954 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6955 unsigned int match_offset)
6956 {
6957 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6958 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6959 */
6960 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6961 (!match_len && match_offset)))
6962 return NULL;
6963
6964 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6965 match, match_len,
6966 match_offset ?
6967 match_offset - 2 : 0);
6968 }
6969
6970 /**
6971 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6972 *
6973 * @eid: element ID
6974 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6975 * @len: length of data
6976 *
6977 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6978 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6979 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6980 * requested element struct.
6981 *
6982 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6983 * having to fit into the given data.
6984 */
6985 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6986 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6987 {
6988 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6989 }
6990
6991 /**
6992 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6993 *
6994 * @eid: element ID
6995 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6996 * @len: length of data
6997 *
6998 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6999 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7000 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
7001 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
7002 *
7003 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7004 * having to fit into the given data.
7005 */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7006 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7007 {
7008 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
7009 }
7010
7011 /**
7012 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
7013 *
7014 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
7015 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7016 * @len: length of data
7017 *
7018 * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
7019 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7020 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
7021 * requested element struct.
7022 *
7023 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7024 * having to fit into the given data.
7025 */
7026 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7027 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7028 {
7029 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
7030 &ext_eid, 1, 0);
7031 }
7032
7033 /**
7034 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
7035 *
7036 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
7037 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7038 * @len: length of data
7039 *
7040 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
7041 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7042 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
7043 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
7044 *
7045 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7046 * having to fit into the given data.
7047 */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7048 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7049 {
7050 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
7051 &ext_eid, 1, 2);
7052 }
7053
7054 /**
7055 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
7056 *
7057 * @oui: vendor OUI
7058 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7059 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7060 * @len: length of data
7061 *
7062 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7063 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
7064 * return the element structure for the requested element.
7065 *
7066 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7067 * the given data.
7068 */
7069 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7070 const u8 *ies,
7071 unsigned int len);
7072
7073 /**
7074 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
7075 *
7076 * @oui: vendor OUI
7077 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7078 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7079 * @len: length of data
7080 *
7081 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7082 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
7083 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
7084 * element ID.
7085 *
7086 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7087 * the given data.
7088 */
7089 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)7090 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7091 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
7092 {
7093 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
7094 }
7095
7096 /**
7097 * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state
7098 * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry
7099 * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success
7100 * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error
7101 */
7102 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret {
7103 RNR_ITER_CONTINUE,
7104 RNR_ITER_BREAK,
7105 RNR_ITER_ERROR,
7106 };
7107
7108 /**
7109 * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries
7110 * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then
7111 * their entries in
7112 * @elems_len: length of the elements
7113 * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7114 * for the return value
7115 * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function
7116 * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries
7117 * or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK),
7118 * %false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR
7119 * or elements were malformed.)
7120 */
7121 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len,
7122 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7123 (*iter)(void *data, u8 type,
7124 const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info,
7125 const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len),
7126 void *iter_data);
7127
7128 /**
7129 * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
7130 *
7131 * @elem: the element to defragment
7132 * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
7133 * @ieslen: length of @ies
7134 * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size
7135 * @data_len: length of @data, or 0
7136 * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
7137 *
7138 * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
7139 *
7140 * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
7141 * skipping all headers.
7142 *
7143 * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
7144 * element in-place.
7145 */
7146 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
7147 size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
7148 u8 frag_id);
7149
7150 /**
7151 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
7152 *
7153 * @dev: network device
7154 * @addr: STA MAC address
7155 *
7156 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
7157 * devices upon STA association.
7158 */
7159 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7160
7161 /**
7162 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
7163 *
7164 * TODO
7165 */
7166
7167 /**
7168 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
7169 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
7170 * conflicts)
7171 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
7172 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
7173 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
7174 * alpha2.
7175 *
7176 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
7177 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
7178 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
7179 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
7180 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
7181 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
7182 *
7183 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
7184 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
7185 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
7186 *
7187 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7188 * an -ENOMEM.
7189 *
7190 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
7191 */
7192 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
7193
7194 /**
7195 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
7196 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7197 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7198 *
7199 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
7200 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
7201 * information.
7202 *
7203 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7204 */
7205 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7206 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7207
7208 /**
7209 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
7210 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7211 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7212 *
7213 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
7214 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
7215 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
7216 *
7217 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7218 */
7219 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7220 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7221
7222 /**
7223 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
7224 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7225 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
7226 *
7227 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
7228 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
7229 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
7230 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
7231 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
7232 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
7233 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
7234 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
7235 * that called this helper.
7236 */
7237 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7238 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
7239
7240 /**
7241 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
7242 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
7243 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
7244 *
7245 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
7246 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
7247 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
7248 * and processed already.
7249 *
7250 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
7251 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
7252 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
7253 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
7254 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
7255 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
7256 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
7257 */
7258 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7259 u32 center_freq);
7260
7261 /**
7262 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
7263 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
7264 *
7265 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
7266 * proper string representation.
7267 *
7268 * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator
7269 */
7270 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
7271
7272 /**
7273 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
7274 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
7275 *
7276 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7277 *
7278 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
7279 */
7280 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7281
7282 /**
7283 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7284 *
7285 */
7286
7287 /**
7288 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7289 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7290 *
7291 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7292 * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7293 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7294 *
7295 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query
7296 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7297 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7298 *
7299 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7300 * an -ENODATA.
7301 *
7302 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7303 */
7304 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7305 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7306
7307 /*
7308 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7309 * functions and BSS handling helpers
7310 */
7311
7312 /**
7313 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7314 *
7315 * @request: the corresponding scan request
7316 * @info: information about the completed scan
7317 */
7318 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7319 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7320
7321 /**
7322 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7323 *
7324 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7325 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7326 */
7327 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7328
7329 /**
7330 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7331 *
7332 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7333 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7334 *
7335 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7336 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
7337 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7338 */
7339 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7340
7341 /**
7342 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7343 *
7344 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7345 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7346 *
7347 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7348 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
7349 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7350 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7351 */
7352 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7353
7354 /**
7355 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7356 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7357 * @data: the BSS metadata
7358 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7359 * @len: length of the management frame
7360 * @gfp: context flags
7361 *
7362 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7363 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7364 *
7365 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7366 * Or %NULL on error.
7367 */
7368 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7369 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7370 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7371 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7372 gfp_t gfp);
7373
7374 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7375 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7376 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7377 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7378 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7379 {
7380 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7381 .chan = rx_channel,
7382 .signal = signal,
7383 };
7384
7385 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7386 }
7387
7388 /**
7389 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7390 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7391 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7392 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7393 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7394 */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)7395 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7396 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7397 {
7398 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7399 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7400 u64 new_bssid_u64;
7401
7402 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7403
7404 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7405
7406 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7407 }
7408
7409 /**
7410 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7411 * @element: element to check
7412 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7413 *
7414 * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise
7415 */
7416 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7417 const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7418
7419 /**
7420 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7421 * @ie: ies
7422 * @ielen: length of IEs
7423 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7424 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7425 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7426 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7427 *
7428 * Return: the number of bytes merged
7429 */
7430 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7431 const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7432 const struct element *sub_elem,
7433 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7434
7435 /**
7436 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7437 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7438 * from a beacon or probe response
7439 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7440 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7441 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon
7442 */
7443 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7444 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7445 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7446 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7447 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON,
7448 };
7449
7450 /**
7451 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7452 * @ie: IEs
7453 * @ielen: length of IEs
7454 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7455 *
7456 * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7457 */
7458 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7459 enum nl80211_band band);
7460
7461 /**
7462 * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7463 * @a: first SSID
7464 * @b: second SSID
7465 *
7466 * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7467 */
7468 static inline bool
cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid * a,struct cfg80211_ssid * b)7469 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7470 {
7471 if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7472 return false;
7473 if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7474 return false;
7475 return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7476 }
7477
7478 /**
7479 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7480 *
7481 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7482 * @data: the BSS metadata
7483 * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7484 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7485 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7486 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7487 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7488 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7489 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7490 * @gfp: context flags
7491 *
7492 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7493 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7494 *
7495 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7496 * Or %NULL on error.
7497 */
7498 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7499 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7500 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7501 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7502 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7503 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7504 gfp_t gfp);
7505
7506 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7507 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7508 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7509 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7510 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7511 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7512 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7513 {
7514 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7515 .chan = rx_channel,
7516 .signal = signal,
7517 };
7518
7519 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7520 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7521 gfp);
7522 }
7523
7524 /**
7525 * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7526 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7527 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7528 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7529 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7530 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7531 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7532 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7533 * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7534 *
7535 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7536 */
7537 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7538 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7539 const u8 *bssid,
7540 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7541 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7542 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7543 u32 use_for);
7544
7545 /**
7546 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7547 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7548 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7549 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7550 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7551 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7552 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7553 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7554 *
7555 * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7556 *
7557 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7558 */
7559 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len,enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)7560 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7561 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7562 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7563 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7564 {
7565 return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7566 bss_type, privacy,
7567 NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7568 }
7569
7570 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7571 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7572 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7573 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7574 {
7575 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7576 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7577 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7578 }
7579
7580 /**
7581 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7582 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7583 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7584 *
7585 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7586 */
7587 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7588
7589 /**
7590 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7591 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7592 * @bss: the BSS struct
7593 *
7594 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7595 */
7596 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7597
7598 /**
7599 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7600 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7601 * @bss: the bss to remove
7602 *
7603 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7604 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7605 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7606 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7607 */
7608 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7609
7610 /**
7611 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7612 *
7613 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7614 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7615 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7616 *
7617 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7618 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7619 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7620 * @iter: the iterator function to call
7621 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7622 */
7623 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7624 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7625 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7626 struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7627 void *data),
7628 void *iter_data);
7629
7630 /**
7631 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7632 * @dev: network device
7633 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7634 * @len: length of the frame data
7635 *
7636 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7637 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7638 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7639 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7640 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7641 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7642 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7643 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7644 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7645 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7646 *
7647 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7648 */
7649 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7650
7651 /**
7652 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7653 * @dev: network device
7654 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7655 *
7656 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7657 * mutex.
7658 */
7659 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7660
7661 /**
7662 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7663 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7664 * @len: length of the frame data
7665 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7666 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7667 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7668 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7669 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7670 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7671 * non-MLO connections
7672 * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7673 * pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7674 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7675 * were rejected by the AP.
7676 */
7677 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7678 const u8 *buf;
7679 size_t len;
7680 const u8 *req_ies;
7681 size_t req_ies_len;
7682 int uapsd_queues;
7683 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7684 struct {
7685 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7686 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7687 u16 status;
7688 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7689 };
7690
7691 /**
7692 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7693 * @dev: network device
7694 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7695 *
7696 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7697 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7698 *
7699 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7700 */
7701 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7702 const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7703
7704 /**
7705 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7706 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7707 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7708 * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7709 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7710 * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7711 * other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7712 */
7713 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7714 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7715 struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7716 bool timeout;
7717 };
7718
7719 /**
7720 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7721 * @dev: network device
7722 * @data: data describing the association failure
7723 *
7724 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7725 */
7726 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7727 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7728
7729 /**
7730 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7731 * @dev: network device
7732 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7733 * @len: length of the frame data
7734 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7735 *
7736 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7737 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7738 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7739 * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7740 */
7741 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7742 bool reconnect);
7743
7744 /**
7745 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7746 * @dev: network device
7747 * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7748 * @len: length of the frame data
7749 *
7750 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7751 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7752 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7753 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7754 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7755 *
7756 * This function may sleep.
7757 */
7758 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7759 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7760
7761 /**
7762 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7763 * @dev: network device
7764 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7765 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7766 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7767 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7768 * @gfp: allocation flags
7769 *
7770 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7771 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7772 * primitive.
7773 */
7774 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7775 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7776 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7777
7778 /**
7779 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7780 *
7781 * @dev: network device
7782 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7783 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7784 * @gfp: allocation flags
7785 *
7786 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7787 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7788 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7789 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7790 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7791 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7792 */
7793 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7794 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7795
7796 /**
7797 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7798 * candidate
7799 *
7800 * @dev: network device
7801 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7802 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7803 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7804 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7805 * @gfp: allocation flags
7806 *
7807 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7808 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7809 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7810 */
7811 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7812 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7813 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7814
7815 /**
7816 * DOC: RFkill integration
7817 *
7818 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7819 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7820 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7821 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7822 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7823 *
7824 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7825 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7826 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7827 */
7828
7829 /**
7830 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7831 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7832 * @blocked: block status
7833 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7834 */
7835 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7836 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7837
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7838 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7839 {
7840 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7841 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7842 }
7843
7844 /**
7845 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7846 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7847 */
7848 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7849
7850 /**
7851 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7852 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7853 */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7854 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7855 {
7856 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7857 }
7858
7859 /**
7860 * DOC: Vendor commands
7861 *
7862 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7863 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7864 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7865 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7866 * the configuration mechanism.
7867 *
7868 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7869 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7870 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7871 *
7872 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7873 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7874 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7875 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7876 * managers etc. need.
7877 */
7878
7879 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7880 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7881 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7882 int approxlen);
7883
7884 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7885 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7886 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7887 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7888 unsigned int portid,
7889 int vendor_event_idx,
7890 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7891
7892 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7893
7894 /**
7895 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7896 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7897 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7898 * be put into the skb
7899 *
7900 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7901 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7902 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7903 *
7904 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7905 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7906 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7907 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7908 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7909 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7910 * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7911 *
7912 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7913 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7914 *
7915 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7916 */
7917 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7918 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7919 {
7920 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7921 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7922 }
7923
7924 /**
7925 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7926 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7927 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7928 *
7929 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7930 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7931 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the
7932 * skb regardless of the return value.
7933 *
7934 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7935 */
7936 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7937
7938 /**
7939 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7940 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7941 *
7942 * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7943 *
7944 * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler
7945 */
7946 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7947
7948 /**
7949 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7950 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7951 * @wdev: the wireless device
7952 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7953 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7954 * be put into the skb
7955 * @gfp: allocation flags
7956 *
7957 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7958 * vendor-specific multicast group.
7959 *
7960 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7961 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7962 * attribute.
7963 *
7964 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7965 * skb to send the event.
7966 *
7967 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7968 */
7969 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7970 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7971 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7972 {
7973 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7974 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7975 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7976 }
7977
7978 /**
7979 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7980 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7981 * @wdev: the wireless device
7982 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7983 * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7984 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7985 * be put into the skb
7986 * @gfp: allocation flags
7987 *
7988 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7989 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7990 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7991 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7992 *
7993 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7994 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7995 * attribute.
7996 *
7997 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7998 * skb to send the event.
7999 *
8000 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8001 */
8002 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)8003 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8004 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8005 unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
8006 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
8007 {
8008 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
8009 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
8010 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
8011 }
8012
8013 /**
8014 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
8015 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
8016 * @gfp: allocation flags
8017 *
8018 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8019 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
8020 */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8021 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8022 {
8023 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8024 }
8025
8026 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
8027 /**
8028 * DOC: Test mode
8029 *
8030 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
8031 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
8032 * factory programming.
8033 *
8034 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
8035 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
8036 */
8037
8038 /**
8039 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
8040 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8041 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8042 * be put into the skb
8043 *
8044 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
8045 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
8046 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
8047 *
8048 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
8049 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
8050 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
8051 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
8052 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
8053 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
8054 * must not modify the skb in any other way.
8055 *
8056 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
8057 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
8058 *
8059 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8060 */
8061 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)8062 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
8063 {
8064 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8065 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
8066 }
8067
8068 /**
8069 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
8070 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8071 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
8072 *
8073 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
8074 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
8075 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb
8076 * regardless of the return value.
8077 *
8078 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
8079 */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)8080 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
8081 {
8082 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
8083 }
8084
8085 /**
8086 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
8087 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8088 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8089 * be put into the skb
8090 * @gfp: allocation flags
8091 *
8092 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
8093 * testmode multicast group.
8094 *
8095 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
8096 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
8097 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
8098 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
8099 * in any other way.
8100 *
8101 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
8102 * skb to send the event.
8103 *
8104 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8105 */
8106 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)8107 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
8108 {
8109 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8110 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
8111 approxlen, gfp);
8112 }
8113
8114 /**
8115 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
8116 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8117 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
8118 * @gfp: allocation flags
8119 *
8120 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8121 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
8122 * consumes it.
8123 */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8124 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8125 {
8126 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8127 }
8128
8129 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd),
8130 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd),
8131 #else
8132 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
8133 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
8134 #endif
8135
8136 /**
8137 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
8138 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
8139 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
8140 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
8141 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid.
8142 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
8143 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
8144 * status for a FILS connection.
8145 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8146 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
8147 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
8148 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8149 */
8150 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
8151 const u8 *kek;
8152 size_t kek_len;
8153 bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
8154 u16 erp_next_seq_num;
8155 const u8 *pmk;
8156 size_t pmk_len;
8157 const u8 *pmkid;
8158 };
8159
8160 /**
8161 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
8162 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8163 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8164 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8165 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8166 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8167 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8168 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8169 * case.
8170 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
8171 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
8172 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8173 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
8174 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
8175 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8176 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8177 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8178 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8179 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8180 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8181 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
8182 * zero.
8183 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8184 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
8185 * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
8186 * connected AP info.
8187 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
8188 * %NULL.
8189 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
8190 * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
8191 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
8192 * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
8193 * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
8194 * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
8195 * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
8196 * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
8197 * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
8198 * to be specified.
8199 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
8200 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
8201 * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
8202 */
8203 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
8204 int status;
8205 const u8 *req_ie;
8206 size_t req_ie_len;
8207 const u8 *resp_ie;
8208 size_t resp_ie_len;
8209 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8210 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
8211
8212 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8213 u16 valid_links;
8214 struct {
8215 const u8 *addr;
8216 const u8 *bssid;
8217 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8218 u16 status;
8219 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8220 };
8221
8222 /**
8223 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8224 *
8225 * @dev: network device
8226 * @params: connection response parameters
8227 * @gfp: allocation flags
8228 *
8229 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8230 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8231 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
8232 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
8233 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
8234 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8235 */
8236 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
8237 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
8238 gfp_t gfp);
8239
8240 /**
8241 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8242 *
8243 * @dev: network device
8244 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8245 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
8246 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
8247 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
8248 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
8249 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
8250 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
8251 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8252 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8253 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8254 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8255 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8256 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8257 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8258 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8259 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8260 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8261 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8262 * case.
8263 * @gfp: allocation flags
8264 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8265 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8266 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8267 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8268 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8269 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8270 *
8271 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8272 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8273 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
8274 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
8275 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8276 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8277 */
8278 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8279 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8280 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
8281 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
8282 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
8283 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8284 {
8285 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
8286
8287 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params));
8288 params.status = status;
8289 params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8290 params.links[0].bss = bss;
8291 params.req_ie = req_ie;
8292 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8293 params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8294 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8295 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8296
8297 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp);
8298 }
8299
8300 /**
8301 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8302 *
8303 * @dev: network device
8304 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8305 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8306 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8307 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8308 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8309 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8310 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8311 * the real status code for failures.
8312 * @gfp: allocation flags
8313 *
8314 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8315 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8316 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8317 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8318 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8319 */
8320 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)8321 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8322 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8323 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8324 u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8325 {
8326 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8327 resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8328 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8329 }
8330
8331 /**
8332 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8333 *
8334 * @dev: network device
8335 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8336 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8337 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8338 * @gfp: allocation flags
8339 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8340 *
8341 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8342 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8343 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8344 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8345 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8346 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8347 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8348 */
8349 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8350 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8351 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8352 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8353 {
8354 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8355 gfp, timeout_reason);
8356 }
8357
8358 /**
8359 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8360 *
8361 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8362 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8363 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8364 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8365 * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8366 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8367 * Otherwise zero.
8368 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8369 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8370 * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8371 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8372 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8373 * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8374 * %NULL if %links.bss is set.
8375 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8376 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8377 * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8378 * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8379 */
8380 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8381 const u8 *req_ie;
8382 size_t req_ie_len;
8383 const u8 *resp_ie;
8384 size_t resp_ie_len;
8385 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8386
8387 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8388 u16 valid_links;
8389 struct {
8390 const u8 *addr;
8391 const u8 *bssid;
8392 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8393 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8394 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8395 };
8396
8397 /**
8398 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8399 *
8400 * @dev: network device
8401 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8402 * @gfp: allocation flags
8403 *
8404 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8405 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8406 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8407 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8408 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8409 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8410 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8411 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8412 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8413 * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8414 */
8415 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8416 gfp_t gfp);
8417
8418 /**
8419 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8420 *
8421 * @dev: network device
8422 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8423 * in case of AP/P2P GO
8424 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8425 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8426 * @gfp: allocation flags
8427 *
8428 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8429 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8430 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8431 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8432 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8433 * indicate the 802.11 association.
8434 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8435 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8436 * associated STA/GC.
8437 */
8438 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8439 const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8440
8441 /**
8442 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8443 *
8444 * @dev: network device
8445 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8446 * @ie_len: length of IEs
8447 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8448 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8449 * @gfp: allocation flags
8450 *
8451 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8452 * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8453 */
8454 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8455 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8456 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8457
8458 /**
8459 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8460 * @wdev: wireless device
8461 * @cookie: the request cookie
8462 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8463 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8464 * channel
8465 * @gfp: allocation flags
8466 */
8467 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8468 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8469 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8470
8471 /**
8472 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8473 * @wdev: wireless device
8474 * @cookie: the request cookie
8475 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8476 * @gfp: allocation flags
8477 */
8478 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8479 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8480 gfp_t gfp);
8481
8482 /**
8483 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8484 * @wdev: wireless device
8485 * @cookie: the requested cookie
8486 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8487 * @gfp: allocation flags
8488 */
8489 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8490 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8491
8492 /**
8493 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8494 *
8495 * @sinfo: the station information
8496 * @gfp: allocation flags
8497 *
8498 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8499 */
8500 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8501
8502 /**
8503 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8504 * @sinfo: the station information
8505 *
8506 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8507 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8508 * the stack.)
8509 */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)8510 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8511 {
8512 kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8513 }
8514
8515 /**
8516 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8517 *
8518 * @dev: the netdev
8519 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8520 * @sinfo: the station information
8521 * @gfp: allocation flags
8522 */
8523 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8524 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8525
8526 /**
8527 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8528 * @dev: the netdev
8529 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8530 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8531 * @gfp: allocation flags
8532 */
8533 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8534 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8535
8536 /**
8537 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8538 *
8539 * @dev: the netdev
8540 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8541 * @gfp: allocation flags
8542 */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8543 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8544 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8545 {
8546 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8547 }
8548
8549 /**
8550 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8551 *
8552 * @dev: the netdev
8553 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8554 * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8555 * @gfp: allocation flags
8556 *
8557 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8558 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8559 * for some reasons, this function is called.
8560 *
8561 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8562 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8563 */
8564 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8565 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8566 gfp_t gfp);
8567
8568 /**
8569 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8570 *
8571 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8572 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8573 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8574 * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8575 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on
8576 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8577 * @len: length of the frame data
8578 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8579 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8580 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8581 */
8582 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8583 int freq;
8584 int sig_dbm;
8585 bool have_link_id;
8586 u8 link_id;
8587 const u8 *buf;
8588 size_t len;
8589 u32 flags;
8590 u64 rx_tstamp;
8591 u64 ack_tstamp;
8592 };
8593
8594 /**
8595 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8596 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8597 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8598 *
8599 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8600 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8601 *
8602 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8603 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8604 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8605 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8606 */
8607 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8608 struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8609
8610 /**
8611 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8612 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8613 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8614 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8615 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8616 * @len: length of the frame data
8617 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8618 *
8619 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8620 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8621 *
8622 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8623 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8624 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8625 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8626 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8627 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8628 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8629 u32 flags)
8630 {
8631 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8632 .freq = freq,
8633 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8634 .buf = buf,
8635 .len = len,
8636 .flags = flags
8637 };
8638
8639 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8640 }
8641
8642 /**
8643 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8644 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8645 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8646 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8647 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8648 * @len: length of the frame data
8649 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8650 *
8651 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8652 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8653 *
8654 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8655 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8656 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8657 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8658 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8659 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8660 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8661 u32 flags)
8662 {
8663 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8664 .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8665 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8666 .buf = buf,
8667 .len = len,
8668 .flags = flags
8669 };
8670
8671 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8672 }
8673
8674 /**
8675 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8676 *
8677 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8678 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8679 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8680 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8681 * @len: length of the frame data
8682 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8683 */
8684 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8685 u64 cookie;
8686 u64 tx_tstamp;
8687 u64 ack_tstamp;
8688 const u8 *buf;
8689 size_t len;
8690 bool ack;
8691 };
8692
8693 /**
8694 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8695 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8696 * @status: TX status data
8697 * @gfp: context flags
8698 *
8699 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8700 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8701 * transmission attempt with extended info.
8702 */
8703 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8704 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8705
8706 /**
8707 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8708 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8709 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8710 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8711 * @len: length of the frame data
8712 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8713 * @gfp: context flags
8714 *
8715 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8716 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8717 * transmission attempt.
8718 */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8719 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8720 u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8721 size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8722 {
8723 struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8724 .cookie = cookie,
8725 .buf = buf,
8726 .len = len,
8727 .ack = ack
8728 };
8729
8730 cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8731 }
8732
8733 /**
8734 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8735 * port frames
8736 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8737 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8738 * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8739 * @len: length of the frame data
8740 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8741 * @gfp: context flags
8742 *
8743 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8744 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8745 * the transmission attempt.
8746 */
8747 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8748 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8749 gfp_t gfp);
8750
8751 /**
8752 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8753 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8754 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf
8755 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear.
8756 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8757 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that
8758 * skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8759 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8760 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8761 *
8762 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8763 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8764 * control port frames over nl80211.
8765 *
8766 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8767 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8768 *
8769 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8770 */
8771 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8772 bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8773
8774 /**
8775 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8776 * @dev: network device
8777 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8778 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8779 * @gfp: context flags
8780 *
8781 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8782 * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8783 */
8784 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8785 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8786 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8787
8788 /**
8789 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8790 * @dev: network device
8791 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8792 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8793 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8794 * threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8795 * @gfp: context flags
8796 */
8797 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8798 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8799
8800 /**
8801 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8802 * @dev: network device
8803 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8804 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8805 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8806 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8807 * @gfp: context flags
8808 *
8809 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8810 * given interval is exceeded.
8811 */
8812 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8813 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8814
8815 /**
8816 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8817 * @dev: network device
8818 * @gfp: context flags
8819 *
8820 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8821 */
8822 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8823
8824 /**
8825 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8826 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8827 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8828 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8829 * @gfp: context flags
8830 *
8831 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8832 */
8833 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8834 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8835 bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8836
8837 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8838 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8839 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8840 gfp_t gfp)
8841 {
8842 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8843 }
8844
8845 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8846 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8847 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8848 gfp_t gfp)
8849 {
8850 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8851 }
8852
8853 /**
8854 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8855 * @dev: network device
8856 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8857 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8858 * @gfp: context flags
8859 *
8860 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8861 * frame.
8862 */
8863 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8864 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8865 gfp_t gfp);
8866
8867 /**
8868 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8869 * @netdev: network device
8870 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8871 * @event: type of event
8872 * @gfp: context flags
8873 * @link_id: valid link_id for MLO operation or 0 otherwise.
8874 *
8875 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8876 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8877 * also by full-MAC drivers.
8878 */
8879 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8880 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8881 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp,
8882 unsigned int link_id);
8883
8884 /**
8885 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8886 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8887 *
8888 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8889 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8890 */
8891 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8892
8893 /**
8894 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8895 * @dev: network device
8896 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8897 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8898 * @gfp: allocation flags
8899 */
8900 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8901 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8902
8903 /**
8904 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8905 * @dev: network device
8906 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8907 * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8908 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8909 * @gfp: allocation flags
8910 */
8911 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8912 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8913
8914 /**
8915 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8916 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8917 * @addr: the transmitter address
8918 * @gfp: context flags
8919 *
8920 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8921 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8922 * sender.
8923 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8924 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8925 */
8926 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8927 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8928
8929 /**
8930 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8931 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8932 * @addr: the transmitter address
8933 * @gfp: context flags
8934 *
8935 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8936 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8937 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8938 * station to avoid event flooding.
8939 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8940 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8941 */
8942 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8943 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8944
8945 /**
8946 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8947 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8948 * @addr: the address of the peer
8949 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8950 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8951 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8952 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8953 * @gfp: allocation flags
8954 */
8955 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8956 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8957 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8958
8959 /**
8960 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8961 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8962 * @frame: the frame
8963 * @len: length of the frame
8964 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8965 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8966 *
8967 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8968 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8969 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8970 */
8971 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8972 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8973
8974 /**
8975 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8976 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8977 * @frame: the frame
8978 * @len: length of the frame
8979 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8980 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8981 *
8982 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8983 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8984 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8985 */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8986 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8987 const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8988 int freq, int sig_dbm)
8989 {
8990 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8991 sig_dbm);
8992 }
8993
8994 /**
8995 * struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config - beacon check configuration
8996 * @iftype: the interface type to check for
8997 * @relax: allow IR-relaxation conditions to apply (e.g. another
8998 * interface connected already on the same channel)
8999 * NOTE: If this is set, wiphy mutex must be held.
9000 * @reg_power: &enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power value indicating the
9001 * advertised/used 6 GHz regulatory power setting
9002 */
9003 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config {
9004 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
9005 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power reg_power;
9006 bool relax;
9007 };
9008
9009 /**
9010 * cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing - check if beaconing is allowed
9011 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9012 * @chandef: the channel definition
9013 * @cfg: additional parameters for the checking
9014 *
9015 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9016 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
9017 */
9018 bool cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9019 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9020 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config *cfg);
9021
9022 /**
9023 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
9024 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9025 * @chandef: the channel definition
9026 * @iftype: interface type
9027 *
9028 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9029 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
9030 */
9031 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)9032 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9033 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9034 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9035 {
9036 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9037 .iftype = iftype,
9038 };
9039
9040 return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9041 }
9042
9043 /**
9044 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
9045 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9046 * @chandef: the channel definition
9047 * @iftype: interface type
9048 *
9049 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9050 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
9051 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
9052 * more permissive conditions.
9053 *
9054 * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
9055 */
9056 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)9057 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9058 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9059 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9060 {
9061 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9062 .iftype = iftype,
9063 .relax = true,
9064 };
9065
9066 return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9067 }
9068
9069 /**
9070 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
9071 * @dev: the device which switched channels
9072 * @chandef: the new channel definition
9073 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9074 *
9075 * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
9076 * driver context!
9077 */
9078 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9079 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9080 unsigned int link_id);
9081
9082 /**
9083 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
9084 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
9085 * @chandef: the future channel definition
9086 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9087 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
9088 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
9089 *
9090 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
9091 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
9092 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
9093 */
9094 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9095 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9096 unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
9097 bool quiet);
9098
9099 /**
9100 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
9101 *
9102 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9103 * @band: band pointer to fill
9104 *
9105 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9106 */
9107 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
9108 enum nl80211_band *band);
9109
9110 /**
9111 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef
9112 *
9113 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9114 * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert
9115 * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef
9116 *
9117 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9118 */
9119 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class,
9120 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
9121 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9122
9123 /**
9124 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
9125 *
9126 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9127 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
9128 *
9129 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9130 */
9131 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9132 u8 *op_class);
9133
9134 /**
9135 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
9136 *
9137 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9138 *
9139 * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
9140 */
9141 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)9142 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
9143 {
9144 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
9145 }
9146
9147 /**
9148 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
9149 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
9150 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
9151 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
9152 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
9153 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
9154 * @gfp: allocation flags
9155 *
9156 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
9157 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
9158 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
9159 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
9160 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
9161 */
9162 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
9163 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
9164 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
9165
9166 /**
9167 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
9168 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
9169 *
9170 * Return: calculated bitrate
9171 */
9172 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
9173
9174 /**
9175 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
9176 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
9177 *
9178 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
9179 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
9180 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
9181 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
9182 * is unbound from the driver.
9183 *
9184 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9185 */
9186 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9187
9188 /**
9189 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
9190 * @dev: the netdev to register
9191 *
9192 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9193 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
9194 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
9195 * instead as well.
9196 *
9197 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9198 *
9199 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9200 */
9201 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
9202
9203 /**
9204 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
9205 * @dev: the netdev to register
9206 *
9207 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9208 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
9209 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
9210 * usable instead as well.
9211 *
9212 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9213 */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)9214 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
9215 {
9216 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
9217 }
9218
9219 /**
9220 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
9221 * @ies: FT IEs
9222 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
9223 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
9224 * @ric_ies: RIC IE
9225 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
9226 */
9227 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
9228 const u8 *ies;
9229 size_t ies_len;
9230 const u8 *target_ap;
9231 const u8 *ric_ies;
9232 size_t ric_ies_len;
9233 };
9234
9235 /**
9236 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
9237 * @netdev: network device
9238 * @ft_event: IE information
9239 */
9240 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9241 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
9242
9243 /**
9244 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
9245 * @ies: the input IE buffer
9246 * @len: the input length
9247 * @attr: the attribute ID to find
9248 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
9249 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
9250 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
9251 *
9252 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
9253 * copies its contents to the given buffer.
9254 *
9255 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
9256 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
9257 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
9258 */
9259 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
9260 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
9261 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
9262
9263 /**
9264 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
9265 * @ies: the IE buffer
9266 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9267 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9268 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9269 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9270 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9271 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
9272 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
9273 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9274 *
9275 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9276 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9277 * split.
9278 *
9279 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9280 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9281 *
9282 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9283 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9284 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9285 *
9286 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9287 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9288 * used.
9289 */
9290 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9291 const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
9292 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
9293 size_t offset);
9294
9295 /**
9296 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
9297 * @ies: the IE buffer
9298 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9299 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9300 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9301 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9302 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9303 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9304 *
9305 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9306 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9307 * split.
9308 *
9309 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9310 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9311 *
9312 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9313 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9314 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9315 *
9316 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9317 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9318 * used.
9319 */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)9320 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9321 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
9322 {
9323 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
9324 }
9325
9326 /**
9327 * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
9328 * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
9329 * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
9330 * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
9331 *
9332 * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
9333 * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
9334 * accordingly.
9335 */
9336 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
9337
9338 /**
9339 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
9340 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
9341 * @wakeup: the wakeup report
9342 * @gfp: allocation flags
9343 *
9344 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
9345 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
9346 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
9347 * else caused the wakeup.
9348 */
9349 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9350 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9351 gfp_t gfp);
9352
9353 /**
9354 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9355 *
9356 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9357 * @gfp: allocation flags
9358 *
9359 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9360 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9361 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9362 */
9363 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9364
9365 /**
9366 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9367 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9368 *
9369 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9370 */
9371 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9372
9373 /**
9374 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9375 *
9376 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9377 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9378 *
9379 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9380 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9381 * the interface combinations.
9382 *
9383 * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error.
9384 */
9385 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9386 struct iface_combination_params *params);
9387
9388 /**
9389 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9390 *
9391 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9392 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9393 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9394 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9395 *
9396 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9397 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9398 * purposes.
9399 *
9400 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9401 */
9402 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9403 struct iface_combination_params *params,
9404 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9405 void *data),
9406 void *data);
9407
9408 /**
9409 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9410 *
9411 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9412 * @wdev: wireless device
9413 * @gfp: context flags
9414 *
9415 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9416 * disconnected.
9417 *
9418 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9419 */
9420 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9421 gfp_t gfp);
9422
9423 /**
9424 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9425 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9426 *
9427 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9428 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9429 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9430 * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9431 *
9432 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9433 * the driver while the function is running.
9434 */
9435 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9436
9437 /**
9438 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9439 *
9440 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9441 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9442 *
9443 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9444 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9445 */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9446 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9447 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9448 {
9449 u8 *ft_byte;
9450
9451 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9452 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9453 }
9454
9455 /**
9456 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9457 *
9458 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9459 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9460 *
9461 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9462 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9463 *
9464 * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise
9465 */
9466 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9467 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9468 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9469 {
9470 u8 ft_byte;
9471
9472 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9473 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9474 }
9475
9476 /**
9477 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9478 * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9479 *
9480 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9481 */
9482 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9483
9484 /**
9485 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9486 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9487 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9488 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9489 * result.
9490 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9491 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9492 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9493 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9494 * @info_len: the length of the &info
9495 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9496 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9497 */
9498 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9499 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9500 u8 inst_id;
9501 u8 peer_inst_id;
9502 const u8 *addr;
9503 u8 info_len;
9504 const u8 *info;
9505 u64 cookie;
9506 };
9507
9508 /**
9509 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9510 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9511 * @match: match notification parameters
9512 * @gfp: allocation flags
9513 *
9514 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9515 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9516 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9517 */
9518 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9519 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9520
9521 /**
9522 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9523 *
9524 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9525 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9526 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9527 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9528 * @gfp: allocation flags
9529 *
9530 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9531 */
9532 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9533 u8 inst_id,
9534 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9535 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9536
9537 /* ethtool helper */
9538 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9539
9540 /**
9541 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9542 * @netdev: network device
9543 * @params: External authentication parameters
9544 * @gfp: allocation flags
9545 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9546 */
9547 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9548 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9549 gfp_t gfp);
9550
9551 /**
9552 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9553 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9554 * @req: the original measurement request
9555 * @result: the result data
9556 * @gfp: allocation flags
9557 */
9558 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9559 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9560 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9561 gfp_t gfp);
9562
9563 /**
9564 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9565 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9566 * @req: the original measurement request
9567 * @gfp: allocation flags
9568 *
9569 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9570 * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9571 */
9572 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9573 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9574 gfp_t gfp);
9575
9576 /**
9577 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9578 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9579 * @iftype: interface type
9580 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9581 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9582 *
9583 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9584 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9585 * check_swif is '1'.
9586 *
9587 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
9588 */
9589 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9590 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9591
9592
9593 /**
9594 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9595 * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9596 * @netdev: network device
9597 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9598 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9599 *
9600 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9601 */
9602 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9603 const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9604
9605 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9606
9607 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9608
9609 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \
9610 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9611 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9612 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9613 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \
9614 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9615 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \
9616 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9617 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \
9618 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9619 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \
9620 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9621 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \
9622 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9623 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \
9624 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9625 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \
9626 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9627
9628 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9629 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9630 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9631 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9632
9633 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \
9634 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9635
9636 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9637 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9638
9639 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9640 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg
9641 #else
9642 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9643 ({ \
9644 if (0) \
9645 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \
9646 0; \
9647 })
9648 #endif
9649
9650 /*
9651 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9652 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9653 * file/line information and a backtrace.
9654 */
9655 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \
9656 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9657
9658 /**
9659 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9660 * @netdev: network device
9661 * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9662 * @gfp: allocation flags
9663 */
9664 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9665 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9666 gfp_t gfp);
9667
9668 /**
9669 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9670 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9671 */
9672 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9673
9674 /**
9675 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9676 * @dev: network device
9677 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9678 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9679 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9680 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9681 *
9682 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9683 */
9684 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9685 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9686 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
9687
9688 /**
9689 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9690 * @dev: network device
9691 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9692 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9693 *
9694 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9695 */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,u8 link_id)9696 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9697 u64 color_bitmap,
9698 u8 link_id)
9699 {
9700 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9701 0, color_bitmap, link_id);
9702 }
9703
9704 /**
9705 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9706 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9707 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9708 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9709 *
9710 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9711 *
9712 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9713 */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count,u8 link_id)9714 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9715 u8 count, u8 link_id)
9716 {
9717 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9718 count, 0, link_id);
9719 }
9720
9721 /**
9722 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9723 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9724 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9725 *
9726 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9727 *
9728 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9729 */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9730 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9731 u8 link_id)
9732 {
9733 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9734 0, 0, link_id);
9735 }
9736
9737 /**
9738 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9739 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9740 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9741 *
9742 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9743 *
9744 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9745 */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9746 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9747 u8 link_id)
9748 {
9749 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9750 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9751 0, 0, link_id);
9752 }
9753
9754 /**
9755 * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9756 * @dev: network device.
9757 * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9758 *
9759 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9760 * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9761 * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9762 * case disconnect instead.
9763 * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9764 */
9765 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9766
9767 /**
9768 * struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data - MLO reconfiguration data
9769 * @buf: MLO Reconfiguration Response frame (header + body)
9770 * @len: length of the frame data
9771 * @driver_initiated: Indicates whether the add links request is initiated by
9772 * driver. This is set to true when the link reconfiguration request
9773 * initiated by driver due to AP link recommendation requests
9774 * (Ex: BTM (BSS Transition Management) request) handling offloaded to
9775 * driver.
9776 * @added_links: BIT mask of links successfully added to the association
9777 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID
9778 * @links.bss: the BSS that MLO reconfiguration was requested for, ownership of
9779 * the pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to
9780 * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done().
9781 *
9782 * The BSS pointer must be set for each link for which 'add' operation was
9783 * requested in the assoc_ml_reconf callback.
9784 */
9785 struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data {
9786 const u8 *buf;
9787 size_t len;
9788 bool driver_initiated;
9789 u16 added_links;
9790 struct {
9791 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
9792 u8 *addr;
9793 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
9794 };
9795
9796 /**
9797 * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done - Notify about MLO reconfiguration result
9798 * @dev: network device.
9799 * @data: MLO reconfiguration done data, &struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data
9800 *
9801 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace that processing of ML reconfiguration
9802 * request to add links to the association is done.
9803 */
9804 void cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(struct net_device *dev,
9805 struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data *data);
9806
9807 /**
9808 * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9809 * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9810 *
9811 * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9812 * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9813 * hold anymore.
9814 */
9815 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9816
9817 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9818 /**
9819 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9820 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9821 * @file: the file being read
9822 * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9823 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9824 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9825 * @count: read count
9826 * @ppos: read position
9827 * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9828 * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9829 *
9830 * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno
9831 */
9832 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9833 char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9834 char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9835 loff_t *ppos,
9836 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9837 struct file *file,
9838 char *buf,
9839 size_t bufsize,
9840 void *data),
9841 void *data);
9842
9843 /**
9844 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9845 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9846 * @file: the file being written to
9847 * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9848 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9849 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9850 * @count: read count
9851 * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9852 * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9853 *
9854 * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno
9855 */
9856 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9857 char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9858 const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9859 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9860 struct file *file,
9861 char *buf,
9862 size_t count,
9863 void *data),
9864 void *data);
9865 #endif
9866
9867 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9868